1 ==============================
2 LLVM Language Reference Manual
3 ==============================
12 This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
13 is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
14 type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
15 representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
16 representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
22 The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
23 forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
24 (suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
25 readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
26 powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
27 transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
28 and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
29 all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
30 representation and notation.
32 The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
33 being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
34 a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
35 high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
36 microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
37 be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
38 the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
39 can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
40 the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
41 instead of a memory location.
48 It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
49 assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
50 and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
51 instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
57 because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
58 LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
59 verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
60 run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
61 before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
62 pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
69 LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
70 identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
71 character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
72 ``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
73 identifiers, for different purposes:
75 #. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
78 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
79 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
82 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
83 can be used on global values to suppress mangling.
84 #. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
86 #. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
88 LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
89 don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
90 of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
91 Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
92 with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
95 Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
96 languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
97 '``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
98 '``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
99 with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
100 (``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
102 Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8
111 After strength reduction:
115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3
121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
123 %result = add i32 %1, %1
125 This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
126 lexical features of LLVM:
128 #. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
129 #. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
130 not assigned to a named value.
131 #. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
135 named, then it will get number 0.
137 It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
138 demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
139 that defines the type and name of value produced.
147 LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
148 translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
149 functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
150 combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
151 global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
152 symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
159 ; External declaration of the puts function
160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
162 ; Definition of main function
163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8*...
165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
176 This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
177 "``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
178 :ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
179 :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
181 In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
182 functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
183 represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
184 to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
185 following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
192 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
198 code into a module with a private global value may cause the
199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
206 ``available_externally``
207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted into
208 the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker's
209 perspective, an ``available_externally`` global is equivalent to
210 an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other
211 optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the
212 global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals
213 with ``available_externally`` linkage are allowed to be discarded at
214 will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is
215 only allowed on definitions, not declarations.
217 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
218 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
219 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
220 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
221 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
222 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
223 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
224 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
225 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
226 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
227 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
228 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
230 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
231 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
232 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
235 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
236 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
237 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
238 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
239 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
240 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
241 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
244 .. _linkage_appending:
247 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
248 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
249 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
250 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
251 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
254 Unfortunately this doesn't correspond to any feature in .o files, so it
255 can only be used for variables like ``llvm.global_ctors`` which llvm
256 interprets specially.
259 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
260 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
261 instead of being an undefined reference.
262 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
263 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
264 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
265 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
266 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
267 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
268 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
269 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
271 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
272 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
273 resolve external symbol references.
275 It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
276 other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
283 LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
284 :ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
285 specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
286 caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
287 The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
290 "``ccc``" - The C calling convention
291 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
292 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
293 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
294 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
295 the function (as does normal C).
296 "``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
297 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
298 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
299 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
300 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
301 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
302 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
303 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
304 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
305 match the prototype of the function definition.
306 "``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
307 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
308 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
309 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
310 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
311 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
312 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
313 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
315 "``cc 10``" - GHC convention
316 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
317 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
318 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
319 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
320 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
321 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
322 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
323 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
326 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
327 floating-point types are supported.
328 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
329 floating-point parameters.
331 This calling convention supports `tail call
332 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
333 caller and callee are using it.
334 "``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
335 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
336 the `High-Performance Erlang
337 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
338 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
339 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
340 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
341 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
342 convention properly supports `tail call
343 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
344 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
345 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
346 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
347 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
349 "``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
350 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
351 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
352 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
353 platform's customary return register.
354 "``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
355 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
356 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
357 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
358 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
359 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
360 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
361 "``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
362 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
363 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
364 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
365 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
366 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
367 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
368 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
369 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
371 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
372 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
373 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
375 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
376 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
377 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
378 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
379 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
380 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
381 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
382 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
383 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
384 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
385 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
387 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
388 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
389 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
390 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
391 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
392 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
394 "``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
395 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
396 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
397 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
398 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
399 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
400 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
401 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
402 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
403 returned in callee-saved registers.
405 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
406 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
407 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
409 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
410 that don't need to call out to any other functions.
412 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
413 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
414 experimental at this time.
415 "``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions
416 Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access
417 function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization
418 block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access
419 a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific
422 This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by
423 preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are
424 perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
426 This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on
427 how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
428 caller/callee-saved registers.
430 Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set
431 of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`.
433 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
435 "``swiftcc``" - This calling convention is used for Swift language.
436 - On X86-64 RCX and R8 are available for additional integer returns, and
437 XMM2 and XMM3 are available for additional FP/vector returns.
438 - On iOS platforms, we use AAPCS-VFP calling convention.
439 "``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
440 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
441 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
442 calling conventions start at 64.
444 More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
445 support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
448 .. _visibilitystyles:
453 All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
456 "``default``" - Default style
457 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
458 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
459 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
460 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
461 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
462 linkage" in the language.
463 "``hidden``" - Hidden style
464 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
465 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
466 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
467 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
468 library) can reference it directly.
469 "``protected``" - Protected style
470 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
471 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
472 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
473 cannot be overridden by another module.
475 A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
483 All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
487 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
488 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
489 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
490 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
492 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
493 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
494 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
495 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
496 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
497 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
501 Thread Local Storage Models
502 ---------------------------
504 A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
505 not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
506 variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
507 TLS model may be specified:
510 For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
512 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
514 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
516 If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
518 The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
519 Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
520 more information on under which circumstances the different models may
521 be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
522 model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
524 A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how
525 the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
527 For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls
528 flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
530 .. _runtime_preemption_model:
532 Runtime Preemption Specifiers
533 -----------------------------
535 Global variables, functions and aliases may have an optional runtime preemption
536 specifier. If a preemption specifier isn't given explicitly, then a
537 symbol is assumed to be ``dso_preemptable``.
540 Indicates that the function or variable may be replaced by a symbol from
541 outside the linkage unit at runtime.
544 The compiler may assume that a function or variable marked as ``dso_local``
545 will resolve to a symbol within the same linkage unit. Direct access will
546 be generated even if the definition is not within this compilation unit.
553 LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
554 types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
555 are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
556 to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
558 An example of an identified structure specification is:
562 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
564 Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
565 literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
569 Non-Integral Pointer Type
570 -------------------------
572 Note: non-integral pointer types are a work in progress, and they should be
573 considered experimental at this time.
575 LLVM IR optionally allows the frontend to denote pointers in certain address
576 spaces as "non-integral" via the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
577 Non-integral pointer types represent pointers that have an *unspecified* bitwise
578 representation; that is, the integral representation may be target dependent or
579 unstable (not backed by a fixed integer).
581 ``inttoptr`` instructions converting integers to non-integral pointer types are
582 ill-typed, and so are ``ptrtoint`` instructions converting values of
583 non-integral pointer types to integers. Vector versions of said instructions
584 are ill-typed as well.
591 Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
594 Global variable definitions must be initialized.
596 Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
597 case they don't have an initializer.
599 Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
600 to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified. If there
601 is a mismatch between the explicit or inferred section information for the
602 variable declaration and its definition the resulting behavior is undefined.
604 A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
605 the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
606 optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
607 section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
608 initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
611 LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
612 constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
613 capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
614 program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
615 optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
616 units that do not include the definition.
618 As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
619 (i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
620 always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
621 region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
624 Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
625 that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
626 like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
627 initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
628 merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
629 whose address is significant.
631 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
632 not be significant within the module.
634 A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
635 numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
636 may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
637 instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
638 is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
640 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
641 target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
642 Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
645 External declarations may have an explicit section specified. Section
646 information is retained in LLVM IR for targets that make use of this
647 information. Attaching section information to an external declaration is an
648 assertion that its definition is located in the specified section. If the
649 definition is located in a different section, the behavior is undefined.
651 By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
652 variables defined within the module are not modified from their
653 initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
654 true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
655 module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
656 ``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
657 by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
659 An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
660 power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
661 alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
662 convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
663 to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
664 to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
665 case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
666 assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
667 iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
668 iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
670 Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
671 an optional :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`,
672 an optional :ref:`global attributes <glattrs>` and
673 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`.
675 Variables and aliases can have a
676 :ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
680 @<GlobalVarName> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility]
681 [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
682 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace]
683 [ExternallyInitialized]
684 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
685 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
686 [, align <Alignment>] (, !name !N)*
688 For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
689 with an initializer, section, and alignment:
693 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
695 The following example just declares a global variable
699 @G = external global i32
701 The following example defines a thread-local global with the
702 ``initialexec`` TLS model:
706 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
708 .. _functionstructure:
713 LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
714 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`runtime preemption
715 specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
716 style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
717 an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
718 an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
719 :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
720 name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
721 attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
722 an optional address space, an optional section, an optional alignment,
723 an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
724 an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
725 an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
726 an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
727 an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
728 an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
730 LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
731 optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility style
732 <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`, an
733 optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`, an optional ``unnamed_addr``
734 or ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute, an optional address space, a return type,
735 an optional :ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function name, a possibly
736 empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional :ref:`garbage
737 collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`, and an optional
738 :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
740 A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
741 Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
742 (giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
743 and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
744 function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an
745 implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for
746 unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a function
747 entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label "%0",
748 then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc.
750 The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
751 immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
752 to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
753 the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
754 predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
756 LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
757 target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
758 Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
760 An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
761 or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
762 by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
763 is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
764 alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
766 If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
767 be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
769 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
770 not be significant within the module.
772 If an explicit address space is not given, it will default to the program
773 address space from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>`.
777 define [linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
779 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
780 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace] [fn Attrs]
781 [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]] [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant]
782 [prologue Constant] [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
784 The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each
785 argument is of the following form:
789 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
797 Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
798 are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
800 Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
803 Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
804 :ref:`runtime preemption specifier <runtime_preemption_model>`, an optional
805 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
806 <dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
810 @<Name> = [Linkage] [PreemptionSpecifier] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
812 The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
813 ``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
814 might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
816 Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
817 the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
820 If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
821 not be significant within the module.
823 Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
824 some can only be checked when producing an object file:
826 * The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
827 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
829 * No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
830 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
833 * No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
834 would require a relocation, which is not possible.
841 IFuncs, like as aliases, don't create any new data or func. They are just a new
842 symbol that dynamic linker resolves at runtime by calling a resolver function.
844 IFuncs have a name and a resolver that is a function called by dynamic linker
845 that returns address of another function associated with the name.
847 IFunc may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>` and an optional
848 :ref:`visibility style <visibility>`.
852 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] ifunc <IFuncTy>, <ResolverTy>* @<Resolver>
860 Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
862 Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
863 specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
864 that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
865 aliasee computes to, if any.
867 Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
868 choose between keys in two different object files.
872 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
874 The selection kind must be one of the following:
877 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
879 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
882 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
884 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
886 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
889 Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs, and ELF and WebAssembly
890 only support ``any`` as a selection kind.
892 Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
893 the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
897 $foo = comdat largest
898 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
900 define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
904 As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
910 @foo = global i32 2, comdat
913 In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
914 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
915 and another COMDAT section with selection kind
916 ``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
917 section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
919 There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
920 It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
922 The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
923 which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
924 Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
925 linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
926 if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
928 The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
935 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
936 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
938 From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
939 with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
940 COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
943 Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
944 create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
945 COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
946 in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
947 is supplied to `llc`).
949 .. _namedmetadatastructure:
954 Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
955 nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
956 operands for a named metadata.
958 #. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
959 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
960 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
961 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
965 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
970 !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
977 The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
978 *parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
979 used to communicate additional information about the result or
980 parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
981 of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
982 parameter attributes can have the same function type.
984 Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
985 If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
990 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
991 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
992 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
994 Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
995 ``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
997 Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
1000 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1001 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
1002 ABI by the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
1004 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
1005 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
1006 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
1007 the callee (for a return value).
1009 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
1010 in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for
1011 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
1012 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
1013 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
1016 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
1017 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
1018 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
1019 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
1020 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
1021 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
1022 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
1023 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
1024 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
1027 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
1028 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
1029 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
1030 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
1031 makes a target-specific assumption.
1037 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
1038 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
1039 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
1040 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
1041 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
1042 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
1044 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
1045 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
1046 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
1047 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
1048 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
1049 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
1050 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
1052 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
1053 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
1054 behavior is undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
1055 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
1056 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
1057 <int_stackrestore>`.
1059 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
1063 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
1064 structure that is the return value of the function in the source
1065 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
1066 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee not
1067 to trap and to be properly aligned. This is not a valid attribute
1073 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
1074 have the specified alignment.
1076 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
1077 ``byval`` attribute.
1082 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
1083 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
1084 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
1085 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
1086 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
1087 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
1088 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
1089 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
1091 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
1092 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
1094 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
1095 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
1096 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
1097 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
1098 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
1099 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
1100 storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
1103 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
1104 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
1105 attribute for return values. Addresses used in volatile operations
1106 are considered to be captured.
1111 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
1112 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
1113 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1116 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
1117 value. This is a hint to the optimizer and code generator used when
1118 generating the caller, allowing value propagation, tail call optimization,
1119 and omission of register saves and restores in some cases; it is not
1120 checked or enforced when generating the callee. The parameter and the
1121 function return type must be valid operands for the
1122 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a valid attribute for
1123 return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1126 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
1127 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
1128 checked or enforced by LLVM; if the parameter or return pointer is null,
1129 the behavior is undefined.
1131 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1132 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
1133 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
1134 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
1135 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
1136 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
1137 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
1138 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
1139 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
1140 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
1142 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1143 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
1144 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
1145 time. All non-null pointers tagged with
1146 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
1147 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
1148 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
1149 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1150 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1151 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
1152 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
1153 pointer typed parameters.
1156 This indicates that the parameter is the self/context parameter. This is not
1157 a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one
1161 This attribute is motivated to model and optimize Swift error handling. It
1162 can be applied to a parameter with pointer to pointer type or a
1163 pointer-sized alloca. At the call site, the actual argument that corresponds
1164 to a ``swifterror`` parameter has to come from a ``swifterror`` alloca or
1165 the ``swifterror`` parameter of the caller. A ``swifterror`` value (either
1166 the parameter or the alloca) can only be loaded and stored from, or used as
1167 a ``swifterror`` argument. This is not a valid attribute for return values
1168 and can only be applied to one parameter.
1170 These constraints allow the calling convention to optimize access to
1171 ``swifterror`` variables by associating them with a specific register at
1172 call boundaries rather than placing them in memory. Since this does change
1173 the calling convention, a function which uses the ``swifterror`` attribute
1174 on a parameter is not ABI-compatible with one which does not.
1176 These constraints also allow LLVM to assume that a ``swifterror`` argument
1177 does not alias any other memory visible within a function and that a
1178 ``swifterror`` alloca passed as an argument does not escape.
1182 Garbage Collector Strategy Names
1183 --------------------------------
1185 Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
1188 .. code-block:: llvm
1190 define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
1192 The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
1193 <builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
1194 strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
1195 named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
1196 garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
1197 which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
1204 Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
1205 generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
1206 The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
1207 language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
1208 available through the function pointer while still allowing the
1209 function pointer to be called.
1211 To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
1212 function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
1213 index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
1214 the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
1215 with a single ``i32``,
1217 .. code-block:: llvm
1219 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
1221 The prefix data can be referenced as,
1223 .. code-block:: llvm
1225 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
1226 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
1227 %b = load i32, i32* %a
1229 Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
1230 of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
1231 beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
1232 of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
1233 function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
1234 function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
1237 A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
1238 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1239 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1246 The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
1247 be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
1248 function hot-patching and instrumentation.
1250 To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
1251 have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
1252 bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
1253 module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
1254 the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
1255 the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
1256 definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
1257 makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
1259 A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
1260 which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
1262 .. code-block:: text
1264 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
1266 Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
1267 which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
1268 x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
1270 .. code-block:: text
1272 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
1274 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
1276 A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
1277 to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1278 optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1282 Personality Function
1283 --------------------
1285 The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
1286 to use for exception handling.
1293 Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
1294 the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
1295 functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
1296 ``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
1297 group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
1299 An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
1300 object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
1301 to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
1302 different groups are merged.
1304 Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
1305 inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
1307 .. code-block:: llvm
1309 ; Target-independent attributes:
1310 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
1312 ; Target-dependent attributes:
1313 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
1315 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
1316 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
1323 Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
1324 a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
1325 function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
1326 attributes can have the same function type.
1328 Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
1329 If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
1332 .. code-block:: llvm
1334 define void @f() noinline { ... }
1335 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1336 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1337 define void @f() optsize { ... }
1340 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
1341 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
1342 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
1344 ``allocsize(<EltSizeParam>[, <NumEltsParam>])``
1345 This attribute indicates that the annotated function will always return at
1346 least a given number of bytes (or null). Its arguments are zero-indexed
1347 parameter numbers; if one argument is provided, then it's assumed that at
1348 least ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam]`` bytes will be available at the
1349 returned pointer. If two are provided, then it's assumed that
1350 ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam] * CallSite.Args[NumEltsParam]`` bytes are
1351 available. The referenced parameters must be integer types. No assumptions
1352 are made about the contents of the returned block of memory.
1354 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
1355 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
1356 inlining size threshold for this caller.
1358 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
1359 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
1360 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
1361 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
1364 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
1365 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
1366 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
1369 In some parallel execution models, there exist operations that cannot be
1370 made control-dependent on any additional values. We call such operations
1371 ``convergent``, and mark them with this attribute.
1373 The ``convergent`` attribute may appear on functions or call/invoke
1374 instructions. When it appears on a function, it indicates that calls to
1375 this function should not be made control-dependent on additional values.
1376 For example, the intrinsic ``llvm.nvvm.barrier0`` is ``convergent``, so
1377 calls to this intrinsic cannot be made control-dependent on additional
1380 When it appears on a call/invoke, the ``convergent`` attribute indicates
1381 that we should treat the call as though we're calling a convergent
1382 function. This is particularly useful on indirect calls; without this we
1383 may treat such calls as though the target is non-convergent.
1385 The optimizer may remove the ``convergent`` attribute on functions when it
1386 can prove that the function does not execute any convergent operations.
1387 Similarly, the optimizer may remove ``convergent`` on calls/invokes when it
1388 can prove that the call/invoke cannot call a convergent function.
1389 ``inaccessiblememonly``
1390 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that
1391 is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form
1392 of ``readnone``. If the function reads or writes other memory, the
1393 behavior is undefined.
1394 ``inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly``
1395 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is
1396 either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to
1397 by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of ``argmemonly``. If the
1398 function reads or writes other memory, the behavior is undefined.
1400 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
1401 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
1402 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
1405 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
1406 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
1407 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
1408 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
1409 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
1410 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
1411 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
1413 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1414 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
1415 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
1416 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
1418 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
1419 function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
1421 When this attribute is set to true, the jump tables and lookup tables that
1422 can be generated from a switch case lowering are disabled.
1424 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
1425 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
1426 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
1427 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
1428 and on function declarations and definitions.
1430 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
1431 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
1432 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
1433 its parent function.
1435 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
1436 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
1437 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
1438 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
1439 call is dead after inlining.
1441 This attributes disables implicit floating-point instructions.
1443 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1444 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
1445 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
1447 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
1448 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
1449 startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
1451 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
1452 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1454 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1455 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
1456 function ever does dynamically return.
1458 This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself
1459 either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces
1460 undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
1462 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
1463 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
1464 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
1465 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
1466 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
1467 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
1468 ``"null-pointer-is-valid"``
1469 If ``"null-pointer-is-valid"`` is set to ``"true"``, then ``null`` address
1470 in address-space 0 is considered to be a valid address for memory loads and
1471 stores. Any analysis or optimization should not treat dereferencing a
1472 pointer to ``null`` as undefined behavior in this function.
1473 Note: Comparing address of a global variable to ``null`` may still
1474 evaluate to false because of a limitation in querying this attribute inside
1475 constant expressions.
1477 This attribute indicates that this function should be optimized
1478 for maximum fuzzing signal.
1480 This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip
1481 this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
1482 Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector.
1483 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
1484 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
1485 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
1487 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
1488 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
1489 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
1490 candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
1492 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1493 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
1494 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
1495 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
1496 ``"patchable-function"``
1497 This attribute tells the code generator that the code
1498 generated for this function needs to follow certain conventions that
1499 make it possible for a runtime function to patch over it later.
1500 The exact effect of this attribute depends on its string value,
1501 for which there currently is one legal possibility:
1503 * ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` - This style of patchable
1504 function is intended to support patching a function prologue to
1505 redirect control away from the function in a thread safe
1506 manner. It guarantees that the first instruction of the
1507 function will be large enough to accommodate a short jump
1508 instruction, and will be sufficiently aligned to allow being
1509 fully changed via an atomic compare-and-swap instruction.
1510 While the first requirement can be satisfied by inserting large
1511 enough NOP, LLVM can and will try to re-purpose an existing
1512 instruction (i.e. one that would have to be emitted anyway) as
1513 the patchable instruction larger than a short jump.
1515 ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` is currently only supported on
1518 This attribute by itself does not imply restrictions on
1519 inter-procedural optimizations. All of the semantic effects the
1520 patching may have to be separately conveyed via the linkage type.
1522 This attribute indicates that the function will trigger a guard region
1523 in the end of the stack. It ensures that accesses to the stack must be
1524 no further apart than the size of the guard region to a previous
1525 access of the stack. It takes one required string value, the name of
1526 the stack probing function that will be called.
1528 If a function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into
1529 a function with another ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, the resulting
1530 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the caller. If a
1531 function that has a ``"probe-stack"`` attribute is inlined into a
1532 function that has no ``"probe-stack"`` attribute at all, the resulting
1533 function has the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute of the callee.
1535 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
1536 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
1537 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
1538 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1539 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
1540 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
1541 to callers. This means while it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
1542 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods (since they write to memory), there may
1543 be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw exceptions without writing to LLVM
1546 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
1547 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
1548 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
1550 If a readnone function reads or writes memory visible to the program, or
1551 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function reads from
1552 or writes to a readnone pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1554 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1555 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
1556 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1557 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
1558 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1559 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
1560 called with the same set of arguments and global state. This means while it
1561 cannot unwind exceptions by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing methods
1562 (since they write to memory), there may be non-``C++`` mechanisms that throw
1563 exceptions without writing to LLVM visible memory.
1565 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1566 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
1567 the pointer points to.
1569 If a readonly function writes memory visible to the program, or
1570 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function writes to
1571 a readonly pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1572 ``"stack-probe-size"``
1573 This attribute controls the behavior of stack probes: either
1574 the ``"probe-stack"`` attribute, or ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1575 It defines the size of the guard region. It ensures that if the function
1576 may use more stack space than the size of the guard region, stack probing
1577 sequence will be emitted. It takes one required integer value, which
1580 If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is inlined into
1581 a function with another ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute, the resulting
1582 function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute that has the lower
1583 numeric value. If a function that has a ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute is
1584 inlined into a function that has no ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1585 at all, the resulting function has the ``"stack-probe-size"`` attribute
1587 ``"no-stack-arg-probe"``
1588 This attribute disables ABI-required stack probes, if any.
1590 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1591 does not read from memory.
1593 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1594 does not read through this pointer argument (even though it may read from
1595 the memory that the pointer points to).
1597 If a writeonly function reads memory visible to the program, or
1598 has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined. If a function reads
1599 from a writeonly pointer argument, the behavior is undefined.
1601 This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
1602 loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
1603 with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
1604 function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
1607 Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute
1608 in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments.
1610 If an argmemonly function reads or writes memory other than the pointer
1611 arguments, or has other side-effects, the behavior is undefined.
1613 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
1614 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
1615 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
1618 This attribute indicates that
1619 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
1620 protection is enabled for this function.
1622 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
1623 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
1624 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
1625 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
1626 ``sanitize_address``
1627 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
1628 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1630 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
1631 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
1633 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
1634 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1635 ``sanitize_hwaddress``
1636 This attribute indicates that HWAddressSanitizer checks
1637 (dynamic address safety analysis based on tagged pointers) are enabled for
1639 ``speculative_load_hardening``
1640 This attribute indicates that
1641 `Speculative Load Hardening <https://llvm.org/docs/SpeculativeLoadHardening.html>`_
1642 should be enabled for the function body. This is a best-effort attempt to
1643 mitigate all known speculative execution information leak vulnerabilities
1644 that are based on the fundamental principles of modern processors'
1645 speculative execution. These vulnerabilities are classified as "Spectre
1646 variant #1" vulnerabilities typically. Notably, this does not attempt to
1647 mitigate any vulnerabilities where the speculative execution and/or
1648 prediction devices of specific processors can be *completely* undermined
1649 (such as "Branch Target Injection", a.k.a, "Spectre variant #2"). Instead,
1650 this is a target-independent request to harden against the completely
1651 generic risk posed by speculative execution to incorrectly load secret data,
1652 making it available to some micro-architectural side-channel for information
1653 leak. For a processor without any speculative execution or predictors, this
1654 is expected to be a no-op.
1656 When inlining, the attribute is sticky. Inlining a function that carries
1657 this attribute will cause the caller to gain the attribute. This is intended
1658 to provide a maximally conservative model where the code in a function
1659 annotated with this attribute will always (even after inlining) end up
1662 This function attribute indicates that the function does not have any
1663 effects besides calculating its result and does not have undefined behavior.
1664 Note that ``speculatable`` is not enough to conclude that along any
1665 particular execution path the number of calls to this function will not be
1666 externally observable. This attribute is only valid on functions
1667 and declarations, not on individual call sites. If a function is
1668 incorrectly marked as speculatable and really does exhibit
1669 undefined behavior, the undefined behavior may be observed even
1670 if the call site is dead code.
1673 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
1674 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
1675 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
1676 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
1677 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
1678 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
1680 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
1681 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1682 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
1683 ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1685 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1686 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1688 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
1689 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
1690 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
1692 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
1693 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
1696 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1697 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1698 The specific layout rules are:
1700 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1701 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1702 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1703 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1704 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1707 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
1708 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
1709 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
1710 an ``sspreq`` attribute.
1712 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
1713 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
1714 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
1715 will enable protectors for functions with:
1717 - Arrays of any size and type
1718 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
1719 - Calls to alloca().
1720 - Local variables that have had their address taken.
1722 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1723 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1724 The specific layout rules are:
1726 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1727 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1728 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1729 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1730 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1733 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
1735 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
1736 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
1737 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
1739 This attribute indicates that the function was called from a scope that
1740 requires strict floating-point semantics. LLVM will not attempt any
1741 optimizations that require assumptions about the floating-point rounding
1742 mode or that might alter the state of floating-point status flags that
1743 might otherwise be set or cleared by calling this function.
1745 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
1746 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
1747 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
1748 match the thunk target prototype.
1750 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
1751 an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can
1752 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
1753 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
1756 This attribute indicates that no control-flow check will be performed on
1757 the attributed entity. It disables -fcf-protection=<> for a specific
1758 entity to fine grain the HW control flow protection mechanism. The flag
1759 is target independent and currently appertains to a function or function
1762 This attribute indicates that the ShadowCallStack checks are enabled for
1763 the function. The instrumentation checks that the return address for the
1764 function has not changed between the function prolog and eiplog. It is
1765 currently x86_64-specific.
1772 Attributes may be set to communicate additional information about a global variable.
1773 Unlike :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`, attributes on a global variable
1774 are grouped into a single :ref:`attribute group <attrgrp>`.
1781 Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
1782 with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and
1783 ``invoke`` s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
1784 incorrect and will change program semantics.
1788 operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
1789 operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
1790 bundle operand ::= SSA value
1791 tag ::= string constant
1793 Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a
1794 given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
1795 of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
1796 are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the
1797 callee being dispatched to.
1799 Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support
1800 runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While
1801 the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag,
1802 there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand
1803 bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions
1804 are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle. As
1805 long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these
1806 restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the
1807 operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
1809 - The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown
1810 ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
1811 - Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
1812 effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
1813 ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overridden with
1814 callsite specific attributes.
1815 - An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation
1816 of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as
1817 usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
1819 More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
1821 .. _deopt_opbundles:
1823 Deoptimization Operand Bundles
1824 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1826 Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"``
1827 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate
1828 "safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be
1829 used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
1830 specified call site. There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand
1831 bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is
1832 out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
1833 rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
1835 From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
1836 the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``. They read
1837 through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not
1838 otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization
1839 operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
1840 deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
1843 The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
1844 operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site
1845 involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
1846 through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
1847 appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation. The
1848 inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization
1849 continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
1850 E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example
1852 .. code-block:: llvm
1855 call void @x() ;; no deopt state
1856 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
1857 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1862 call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
1868 .. code-block:: llvm
1871 call void @x() ;; still no deopt state
1872 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
1873 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1877 It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the
1878 deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the
1879 caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is
1880 semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization
1881 continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation.
1885 Funclet Operand Bundles
1886 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1888 Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the ``"funclet"``
1889 operand bundle tag. These operand bundles indicate that a call site
1890 is within a particular funclet. There can be at most one
1891 ``"funclet"`` operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have
1892 exactly one bundle operand.
1894 If any funclet EH pads have been "entered" but not "exited" (per the
1895 `description in the EH doc\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
1896 it is undefined behavior to execute a ``call`` or ``invoke`` which:
1898 * does not have a ``"funclet"`` bundle and is not a ``call`` to a nounwind
1900 * has a ``"funclet"`` bundle whose operand is not the most-recently-entered
1901 not-yet-exited funclet EH pad.
1903 Similarly, if no funclet EH pads have been entered-but-not-yet-exited,
1904 executing a ``call`` or ``invoke`` with a ``"funclet"`` bundle is undefined behavior.
1906 GC Transition Operand Bundles
1907 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1909 GC transition operand bundles are characterized by the
1910 ``"gc-transition"`` operand bundle tag. These operand bundles mark a
1911 call as a transition between a function with one GC strategy to a
1912 function with a different GC strategy. If coordinating the transition
1913 between GC strategies requires additional code generation at the call
1914 site, these bundles may contain any values that are needed by the
1915 generated code. For more details, see :ref:`GC Transitions
1916 <gc_transition_args>`.
1920 Module-Level Inline Assembly
1921 ----------------------------
1923 Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
1924 to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1925 concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
1926 in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
1928 .. code-block:: llvm
1930 module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1931 module asm "more can go here"
1933 The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
1934 characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
1935 two digit hex code for the number.
1937 Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
1938 (unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
1940 .. _langref_datalayout:
1945 A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
1946 how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1949 .. code-block:: llvm
1951 target datalayout = "layout specification"
1953 The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
1954 separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
1955 with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
1956 define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
1960 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
1961 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
1964 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
1965 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
1968 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
1969 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
1970 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
1971 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
1972 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
1973 alignment promotions.
1974 ``P<address space>``
1975 Specifies the address space that corresponds to program memory.
1976 Harvard architectures can use this to specify what space LLVM
1977 should place things such as functions into. If omitted, the
1978 program memory space defaults to the default address space of 0,
1979 which corresponds to a Von Neumann architecture that has code
1980 and data in the same space.
1981 ``A<address space>``
1982 Specifies the address space of objects created by '``alloca``'.
1983 Defaults to the default address space of 0.
1984 ``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>:<idx>``
1985 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
1986 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. The fourth parameter
1987 ``<idx>`` is a size of index that used for address calculation. If not
1988 specified, the default index size is equal to the pointer size. All sizes
1989 are in bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified,
1990 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
1991 in the range [1,2^23).
1992 ``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1993 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
1994 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
1995 ``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1996 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
1998 ``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1999 This specifies the alignment for a floating-point type of a given bit
2000 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
2001 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
2002 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
2005 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
2007 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. Symbols
2008 prefixed with the mangling escape character ``\01`` are passed through
2009 directly to the assembler without the escape character. The mangling style
2012 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
2013 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
2014 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
2015 symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
2016 * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF mangling: Private symbols get the usual prefix.
2017 Regular C symbols get a ``_`` prefix. Functions with ``__stdcall``,
2018 ``__fastcall``, and ``__vectorcall`` have custom mangling that appends
2019 ``@N`` where N is the number of bytes used to pass parameters. C++ symbols
2020 starting with ``?`` are not mangled in any way.
2021 * ``w``: Windows COFF mangling: Similar to ``x``, except that normal C
2022 symbols do not receive a ``_`` prefix.
2023 ``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
2024 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
2025 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
2026 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
2027 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
2029 ``ni:<address space0>:<address space1>:<address space2>...``
2030 This specifies pointer types with the specified address spaces
2031 as :ref:`Non-Integral Pointer Type <nointptrtype>` s. The ``0``
2032 address space cannot be specified as non-integral.
2034 On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
2035 ``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
2036 should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
2038 When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
2039 default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
2040 the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
2041 specifications are given in this list:
2043 - ``E`` - big endian
2044 - ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
2045 - ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
2046 same as the default address space.
2047 - ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
2048 - ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2049 - ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
2050 - ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
2051 - ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
2052 - ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
2053 alignment of 64-bits
2054 - ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
2055 - ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
2056 - ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
2057 - ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
2058 - ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
2059 - ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
2060 - ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
2062 When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
2065 #. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
2066 that specification is used.
2067 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
2068 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
2069 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
2070 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
2071 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
2072 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
2073 alignment of i64 (largest specified).
2074 #. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
2075 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
2076 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
2077 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
2079 The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
2080 Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
2081 the code generator should use.
2083 Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
2084 the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
2085 mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
2086 what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
2087 that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
2088 don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
2089 generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
2090 accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
2091 these default specifications.
2098 A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
2099 host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
2101 .. code-block:: llvm
2103 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
2105 The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
2106 by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
2110 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
2111 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
2113 This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
2114 code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
2115 command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
2117 .. _pointeraliasing:
2119 Pointer Aliasing Rules
2120 ----------------------
2122 Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
2123 an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
2124 undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
2125 to the following rules:
2127 - A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
2128 value it is *based* on.
2129 - An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
2130 of the variable's storage.
2131 - The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
2132 address range of the allocated storage.
2133 - A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
2135 - An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
2136 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
2137 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
2138 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
2139 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
2141 A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
2144 - A pointer value formed from a scalar ``getelementptr`` operation is *based* on
2145 the pointer-typed operand of the ``getelementptr``.
2146 - The pointer in lane *l* of the result of a vector ``getelementptr`` operation
2147 is *based* on the pointer in lane *l* of the vector-of-pointers-typed operand
2148 of the ``getelementptr``.
2149 - The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
2151 - A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
2152 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
2153 the pointer's value.
2154 - The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
2156 Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
2157 definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
2159 LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
2160 ``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
2161 which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
2162 operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
2163 alignment of the store.
2165 Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
2166 ``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
2167 :ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
2168 which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
2173 Volatile Memory Accesses
2174 ------------------------
2176 Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
2177 :ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
2178 marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
2179 volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
2180 volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
2181 operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
2182 "volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
2184 IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
2185 llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
2186 flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
2187 target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
2189 .. admonition:: Rationale
2191 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
2192 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
2193 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
2194 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
2195 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
2196 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations
2197 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
2201 Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
2202 --------------------------------------
2204 The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
2205 execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
2206 platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
2207 in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
2209 For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
2211 We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
2214 - Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
2215 - When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
2216 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
2217 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
2218 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
2219 Constraints <ordering>`).
2221 Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
2222 between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
2224 Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
2225 loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
2226 (defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
2227 stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
2228 section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
2229 initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
2230 of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
2231 may see any write to the same byte, except:
2233 - If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
2234 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
2235 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
2236 - If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
2237 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
2239 Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
2241 - If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
2242 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
2243 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
2244 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
2246 - Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
2247 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
2248 - Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
2249 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
2250 - Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
2251 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
2252 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
2253 constraints on how the choice is made.
2254 - Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
2256 R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
2257 implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
2258 the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
2259 semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
2260 than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
2262 Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
2263 model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
2264 is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
2265 which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
2266 (Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
2267 from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
2268 exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
2272 Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
2273 ----------------------------------
2275 Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
2276 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
2277 :ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
2278 ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
2279 the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
2280 from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
2281 descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
2282 references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
2283 :ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
2284 differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
2285 documentation for details.
2287 For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
2291 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
2292 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
2293 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
2294 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
2295 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
2296 to make them atomic in any interesting way.
2298 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
2299 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
2300 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
2301 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
2302 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
2303 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
2304 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
2305 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
2306 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
2307 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
2308 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
2309 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
2310 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
2311 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
2312 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
2313 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2314 ``memory_order_relaxed``.
2316 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
2317 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
2318 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
2320 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
2321 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
2322 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
2323 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
2324 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2325 ``memory_order_release``.
2326 ``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
2327 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
2328 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
2329 ``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
2330 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
2331 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
2332 writes), there is a global total order on all
2333 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
2334 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
2335 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
2336 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
2337 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2338 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
2342 If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``, it only
2343 *synchronizes with* and only participates in the seq\_cst total orderings of
2344 other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal handlers).
2346 If an atomic operation is marked ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``, where
2347 ``<target-scope>`` is a target specific synchronization scope, then it is target
2348 dependent if it *synchronizes with* and participates in the seq\_cst total
2349 orderings of other operations.
2351 Otherwise, an atomic operation that is not marked ``syncscope("singlethread")``
2352 or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` *synchronizes with* and participates in the
2353 seq\_cst total orderings of other operations that are not marked
2354 ``syncscope("singlethread")`` or ``syncscope("<target-scope>")``.
2358 Floating-Point Environment
2359 --------------------------
2361 The default LLVM floating-point environment assumes that floating-point
2362 instructions do not have side effects. Results assume the round-to-nearest
2363 rounding mode. No floating-point exception state is maintained in this
2364 environment. Therefore, there is no attempt to create or preserve invalid
2365 operation (SNaN) or division-by-zero exceptions.
2367 The benefit of this exception-free assumption is that floating-point
2368 operations may be speculated freely without any other fast-math relaxations
2369 to the floating-point model.
2371 Code that requires different behavior than this should use the
2372 :ref:`Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics <constrainedfp>`.
2379 LLVM IR floating-point operations (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
2380 :ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
2381 :ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) and :ref:`call <i_call>`
2382 may use the following flags to enable otherwise unsafe
2383 floating-point transformations.
2386 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2387 NaN. If an argument is a nan, or the result would be a nan, it produces
2388 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` instead.
2391 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2392 +/-Inf. If an argument is +/-Inf, or the result would be +/-Inf, it
2393 produces a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` instead.
2396 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
2397 argument or result as insignificant.
2400 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
2401 argument rather than perform division.
2404 Allow floating-point contraction (e.g. fusing a multiply followed by an
2405 addition into a fused multiply-and-add).
2408 Approximate functions - Allow substitution of approximate calculations for
2409 functions (sin, log, sqrt, etc). See floating-point intrinsic definitions
2410 for places where this can apply to LLVM's intrinsic math functions.
2413 Allow reassociation transformations for floating-point instructions.
2414 This may dramatically change results in floating-point.
2417 This flag implies all of the others.
2421 Use-list Order Directives
2422 -------------------------
2424 Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
2425 order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
2426 indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
2427 value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
2429 Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
2430 instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
2431 function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
2433 If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
2434 ``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
2441 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
2442 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
2448 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
2450 ; ... instructions ...
2452 ; ... instructions ...
2454 ; At function scope.
2455 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
2456 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
2460 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
2461 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
2462 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
2463 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
2465 .. _source_filename:
2470 The *source filename* string is set to the original module identifier,
2471 which will be the name of the compiled source file when compiling from
2472 source through the clang front end, for example. It is then preserved through
2475 This is currently necessary to generate a consistent unique global
2476 identifier for local functions used in profile data, which prepends the
2477 source file name to the local function name.
2479 The syntax for the source file name is simply:
2481 .. code-block:: text
2483 source_filename = "/path/to/source.c"
2490 The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
2491 intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
2492 optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
2493 directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
2494 transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
2495 generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
2496 not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
2506 The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
2524 The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
2525 return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
2526 type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
2527 and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
2533 <returntype> (<parameter list>)
2535 ...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
2536 specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
2537 indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
2538 argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
2539 handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
2540 except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
2544 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2545 | ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` |
2546 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2547 | ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. |
2548 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2549 | ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
2550 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2551 | ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values |
2552 +---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2559 The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
2560 Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
2568 These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
2577 The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
2578 arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
2579 bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
2587 The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
2593 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2594 | ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. |
2595 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2596 | ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. |
2597 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2598 | ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
2599 +----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2603 Floating-Point Types
2604 """"""""""""""""""""
2613 - 16-bit floating-point value
2616 - 32-bit floating-point value
2619 - 64-bit floating-point value
2622 - 128-bit floating-point value (112-bit mantissa)
2625 - 80-bit floating-point value (X87)
2628 - 128-bit floating-point value (two 64-bits)
2630 The binary format of half, float, double, and fp128 correspond to the
2631 IEEE-754-2008 specifications for binary16, binary32, binary64, and binary128
2639 The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
2640 machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
2641 return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
2642 instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
2643 and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
2660 The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
2661 commonly used to reference objects in memory.
2663 Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
2664 numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
2665 address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
2666 are target-specific.
2668 Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
2669 permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
2679 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2680 | ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. |
2681 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2682 | ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
2683 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2684 | ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. |
2685 +-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2694 A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
2695 elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
2696 operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
2697 requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data
2698 type. Vector types are considered :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
2704 < <# elements> x <elementtype> >
2706 The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
2707 elementtype may be any integer, floating-point or pointer type. Vectors
2708 of size zero are not allowed.
2712 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2713 | ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2714 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2715 | ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
2716 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2717 | ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
2718 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2719 | ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
2720 +-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2729 The label type represents code labels.
2744 The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction
2745 but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it.
2746 As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or
2747 :ref:`select <i_select>` of type token.
2764 The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
2765 created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
2778 Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
2779 member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
2780 aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
2790 The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
2791 sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
2792 elements) and an underlying data type.
2798 [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
2800 The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
2801 be any type with a size.
2805 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2806 | ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
2807 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2808 | ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
2809 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2810 | ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
2811 +------------------+--------------------------------------+
2813 Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
2815 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2816 | ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
2817 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2818 | ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating-point values. |
2819 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2820 | ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
2821 +-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2823 There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
2824 by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
2825 bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
2826 single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
2827 LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
2828 arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
2838 The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
2839 together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
2842 Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
2843 getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
2844 Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
2845 '``insertvalue``' instructions.
2847 Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
2848 the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
2849 between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
2850 is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
2851 required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
2853 Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
2854 is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
2855 identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
2856 Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
2857 or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
2858 recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
2864 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
2865 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
2869 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2870 | ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values |
2871 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2872 | ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. |
2873 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2874 | ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
2875 +------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2879 Opaque Structure Types
2880 """"""""""""""""""""""
2884 Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
2885 do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
2886 notion of a forward declared structure.
2897 +--------------+-------------------+
2898 | ``opaque`` | An opaque type. |
2899 +--------------+-------------------+
2906 LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
2907 describes them all and their syntax.
2912 **Boolean constants**
2913 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
2915 **Integer constants**
2916 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
2917 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
2919 **Floating-point constants**
2920 Floating-point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
2921 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
2922 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
2923 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
2924 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
2925 decimal in binary. Floating-point constants must have a
2926 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type.
2927 **Null pointer constants**
2928 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
2929 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
2931 The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant
2932 and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`.
2934 The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
2935 floating-point constants. For example, the form
2936 '``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
2937 than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating-point
2938 constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
2939 disassembler) is when a floating-point constant must be emitted but it
2940 cannot be represented as a decimal floating-point number in a reasonable
2941 number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
2942 values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
2943 and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
2945 When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
2946 double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
2947 matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
2948 must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
2949 precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
2950 double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
2951 by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
2952 128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
2953 ``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
2954 represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
2955 will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
2956 The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
2957 followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
2958 (sign bit at the left).
2960 There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
2962 .. _complexconstants:
2967 Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
2968 constants and smaller complex constants.
2970 **Structure constants**
2971 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
2972 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
2973 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
2974 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
2975 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
2976 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
2977 must match those specified by the type.
2979 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
2980 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2981 square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
2982 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
2983 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
2984 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
2985 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
2986 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
2987 **Vector constants**
2988 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
2989 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2990 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
2991 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
2992 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
2993 elements must match those specified by the type.
2994 **Zero initialization**
2995 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
2996 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
2997 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
2998 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
2999 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
3001 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
3002 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
3003 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
3004 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
3005 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
3006 information such as debug info.
3008 Global Variable and Function Addresses
3009 --------------------------------------
3011 The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
3012 :ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
3013 (link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
3014 the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
3015 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
3018 .. code-block:: llvm
3022 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
3029 The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
3030 indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
3031 bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
3032 or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
3034 Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
3035 the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
3036 compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
3037 (potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
3039 .. code-block:: llvm
3049 This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
3050 bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
3052 .. code-block:: llvm
3060 %A = %X ;; By choosing undef as 0
3061 %B = %X ;; By choosing undef as -1
3066 These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
3067 input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
3068 '``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
3069 the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
3070 optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
3071 However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
3072 0, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
3073 all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
3074 allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
3076 .. code-block:: llvm
3078 %A = select undef, %X, %Y
3079 %B = select undef, 42, %Y
3080 %C = select %X, %Y, undef
3090 This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
3091 branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
3092 of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
3093 both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
3094 cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
3095 allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
3096 ``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
3098 .. code-block:: text
3100 %A = xor undef, undef
3117 This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
3118 necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
3119 C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
3120 ``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
3121 short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
3122 its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
3123 doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
3124 read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
3125 the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
3126 ``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
3127 uses with" concept would not hold.
3129 .. code-block:: llvm
3137 These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
3138 and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
3139 allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
3140 operation can be constant folded to '``0``', because the '``undef``'
3141 could be zero, and zero divided by any value is zero.
3142 However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
3143 assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
3144 we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
3145 has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
3146 does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
3147 code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
3148 optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
3150 .. code-block:: text
3152 a: store undef -> %X
3153 b: store %X -> undef
3158 A store *of* an undefined value can be assumed to not have any effect;
3159 we can assume that the value is overwritten with bits that happen to
3160 match what was already there. However, a store *to* an undefined
3161 location could clobber arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined
3169 Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however
3170 they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression
3171 that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition
3172 that results in undefined behavior.
3174 There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
3175 only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
3178 Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
3180 - Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
3181 - :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
3182 their dynamic predecessor basic block.
3183 - Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
3184 in the dynamic callers of their functions.
3185 - :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
3186 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3187 - :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
3188 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
3189 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
3190 - Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
3191 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
3192 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
3193 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
3194 - An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
3195 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
3196 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
3197 operations <volatile>`.)
3198 - An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
3199 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
3200 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
3201 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
3202 when control is transferred to another.
3203 - Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
3204 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
3205 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
3207 - Dependence is transitive.
3209 Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`,
3210 with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence*
3211 on a poison value has undefined behavior.
3213 Here are some examples:
3215 .. code-block:: llvm
3218 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
3219 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
3220 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
3221 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
3223 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
3224 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
3226 store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior.
3228 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
3229 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
3230 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3231 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
3233 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
3234 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
3237 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
3238 ; it has undefined behavior.
3242 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
3243 ; Both edges into this PHI are
3244 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
3245 ; always results in a poison value.
3247 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
3248 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
3249 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
3251 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
3252 ; The same branch again, but this time the
3253 ; true block doesn't have side effects.
3260 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
3261 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
3262 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
3263 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
3264 ; behavior in this example).
3268 Addresses of Basic Blocks
3269 -------------------------
3271 ``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
3273 The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
3274 basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
3275 Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
3277 This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
3278 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' instruction, or for comparisons
3279 against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in
3280 undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok, and
3281 no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
3282 opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
3283 allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
3284 long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr``
3287 Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
3288 as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
3292 Constant Expressions
3293 --------------------
3295 Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
3296 constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
3297 :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
3298 that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
3299 The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
3301 ``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
3302 Perform the :ref:`trunc operation <i_trunc>` on constants.
3303 ``zext (CST to TYPE)``
3304 Perform the :ref:`zext operation <i_zext>` on constants.
3305 ``sext (CST to TYPE)``
3306 Perform the :ref:`sext operation <i_sext>` on constants.
3307 ``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
3308 Truncate a floating-point constant to another floating-point type.
3309 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
3310 must be floating-point.
3311 ``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
3312 Floating-point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
3313 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
3315 ``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
3316 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding unsigned
3317 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3318 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
3319 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3320 value won't fit in the integer type, the result is a
3321 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
3322 ``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
3323 Convert a floating-point constant to the corresponding signed
3324 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3325 must be of scalar or vector floating-point type. Both CST and TYPE
3326 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3327 value won't fit in the integer type, the result is a
3328 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
3329 ``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3330 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding
3331 floating-point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point
3332 type. CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3333 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements.
3334 ``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3335 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating-point
3336 constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating-point type.
3337 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3338 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements.
3339 ``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
3340 Perform the :ref:`ptrtoint operation <i_ptrtoint>` on constants.
3341 ``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
3342 Perform the :ref:`inttoptr operation <i_inttoptr>` on constants.
3343 This one is *really* dangerous!
3344 ``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
3345 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE.
3346 The constraints of the operands are the same as those for the
3347 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`.
3348 ``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
3349 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
3350 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
3351 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
3352 ``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3353 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
3354 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
3355 instruction, the index list may have one or more indexes, which are
3356 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
3357 ``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
3358 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
3359 ``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3360 Perform the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
3361 ``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3362 Perform the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
3363 ``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
3364 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
3366 ``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
3367 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
3369 ``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
3370 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
3372 ``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3373 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
3374 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
3375 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
3376 least one index value must be specified.
3377 ``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3378 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
3379 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
3380 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
3381 value must be specified.
3382 ``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
3383 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
3384 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
3385 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
3386 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
3387 operations on floating-point values are allowed).
3394 Inline Assembler Expressions
3395 ----------------------------
3397 LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
3398 Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
3399 represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
3400 instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
3401 flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
3402 and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
3403 stack conservatively.
3405 The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
3406 followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
3407 location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
3408 be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
3409 operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
3411 A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
3412 other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
3413 used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
3414 resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
3415 disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
3416 syntax known to LLVM.
3418 LLVM also supports a few more substitions useful for writing inline assembly:
3420 - ``${:uid}``: Expands to a decimal integer unique to this inline assembly blob.
3421 This substitution is useful when declaring a local label. Many standard
3422 compiler optimizations, such as inlining, may duplicate an inline asm blob.
3423 Adding a blob-unique identifier ensures that the two labels will not conflict
3424 during assembly. This is used to implement `GCC's %= special format
3425 string <https://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Extended-Asm.html>`_.
3426 - ``${:comment}``: Expands to the comment character of the current target's
3427 assembly dialect. This is usually ``#``, but many targets use other strings,
3428 such as ``;``, ``//``, or ``!``.
3429 - ``${:private}``: Expands to the assembler private label prefix. Labels with
3430 this prefix will not appear in the symbol table of the assembled object.
3431 Typically the prefix is ``L``, but targets may use other strings. ``.L`` is
3434 LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
3435 GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
3436 modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
3437 support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
3438 described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
3439 while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
3440 translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
3443 An example inline assembler expression is:
3445 .. code-block:: llvm
3447 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
3449 Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
3450 of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
3451 Thus, typically we have:
3453 .. code-block:: llvm
3455 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
3457 Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
3458 marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
3459 '``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
3461 .. code-block:: llvm
3463 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
3465 In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
3466 the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
3467 x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
3468 The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
3469 might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
3470 prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
3472 .. code-block:: llvm
3474 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
3476 Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
3477 assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
3478 the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
3479 the only supported dialects. An example is:
3481 .. code-block:: llvm
3483 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
3485 If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
3486 first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
3489 Inline Asm Constraint String
3490 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3492 The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
3493 more constraint codes.
3495 For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
3496 operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
3497 string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
3500 There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
3501 prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
3502 constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
3503 clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
3505 There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
3507 - Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
3508 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
3509 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
3510 - Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
3511 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
3512 modes used by the target.
3513 - Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
3514 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
3515 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
3516 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
3521 Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
3522 indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
3523 then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
3524 constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
3525 below about indirect outputs).
3527 Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
3528 expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
3529 the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
3530 assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
3531 the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
3532 modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
3533 "early-clobber" output. Marking an output as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
3534 will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
3540 Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
3541 constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
3542 permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
3543 that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
3544 assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
3545 contain the same value.
3547 Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
3548 themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
3549 string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
3550 take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
3551 be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
3552 to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
3553 output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
3556 It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
3557 *other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
3558 (even when the other input has the same value).
3560 You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
3561 memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
3563 There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
3564 register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
3565 type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
3566 registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
3568 However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
3570 Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
3571 architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
3572 instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
3573 SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
3574 hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
3575 feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
3577 A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
3578 to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
3579 ``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
3580 register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
3581 probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
3582 clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
3583 despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
3586 Indirect inputs and outputs
3587 """""""""""""""""""""""""""
3589 Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
3590 (which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
3591 will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
3592 argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
3593 an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
3594 rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
3595 "output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
3596 memory location, instead of just read from it).
3598 This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
3599 address of a variable as a value.
3601 It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
3602 (e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
3603 value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
3604 input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
3605 functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
3606 statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
3607 optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
3613 A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
3614 consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
3615 general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
3616 constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
3617 "``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
3618 memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
3621 Note that clobbering named registers that are also present in output
3622 constraints is not legal.
3627 After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
3629 A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
3630 followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
3633 The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
3634 GCC's constraint codes.
3636 A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
3637 it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
3638 compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
3640 There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
3641 inline asm constraint list:
3643 1) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
3644 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
3645 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
3648 2) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
3649 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
3650 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
3651 constraint list will be chosen together.
3653 Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
3654 ``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
3655 operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
3656 may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
3658 However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
3659 LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
3660 point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
3661 in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
3662 compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
3663 always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
3664 or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
3665 doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
3666 unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
3667 ``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
3670 Supported Constraint Code List
3671 """"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3673 The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3674 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3675 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3676 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3678 Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
3680 - ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
3681 - ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
3682 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
3683 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
3684 - ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
3685 immediate, or a relocatable value.
3686 - ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
3687 - ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
3688 - ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
3689 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
3691 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
3692 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
3694 - ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
3696 Other constraints are target-specific:
3700 - ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
3701 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
3702 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
3703 - ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
3704 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
3705 - ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
3706 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
3707 - ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
3708 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
3709 - ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3710 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
3711 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
3712 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
3713 - ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3714 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
3715 - ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
3716 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
3718 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
3719 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
3720 - ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
3724 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3725 - ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
3726 - ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
3731 - ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
3732 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
3734 ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
3736 - ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
3737 - ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
3738 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
3739 - ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
3740 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
3741 print the inverted value).
3742 - ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
3743 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
3745 - ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
3746 - ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3747 - ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3748 - ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
3749 - ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
3751 - ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
3753 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3754 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3755 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3756 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3757 - ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3762 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
3763 - ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
3764 - ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
3766 - ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
3767 - ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
3768 - ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3769 - ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
3770 - ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3771 - ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3772 - ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3773 - ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3774 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3775 - ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3776 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3777 - ``t``: A low floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``, ``d0-d16``, or
3783 - ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
3785 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
3789 - ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
3793 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3794 - ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
3795 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3796 - ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
3797 - ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
3798 - ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
3799 - ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
3800 - ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3801 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
3802 - ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3803 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
3805 - ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
3806 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
3807 - ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
3808 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
3809 (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w``
3810 argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.
3811 - ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
3813 - ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
3818 - ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
3819 - ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
3820 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3821 - ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
3822 - ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
3823 - ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
3828 - ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3829 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3830 - ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3831 - ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3832 - ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
3833 - ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
3834 - ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
3835 - ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
3837 - ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
3838 treated the same as ``m``.
3839 - ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3840 - ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
3842 - ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
3843 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
3844 - ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
3845 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
3846 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
3848 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
3849 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
3851 - ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
3852 - ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
3853 - ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
3854 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
3855 - ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating-point register, from the full VSX register
3860 - ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
3861 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3862 - ``f``: Any floating-point register on SparcV8, or a floating-point
3863 register in the "low" half of the registers on SparcV9.
3864 - ``e``: Any floating-point register. (Same as ``f`` on SparcV8.)
3868 - ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3869 - ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
3870 - ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3871 - ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
3872 - ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
3873 - ``Q``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 12-bit immediate
3874 unsigned displacement.
3875 - ``R``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 12-bit immediate
3876 unsigned displacement, and an index register.
3877 - ``S``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 20-bit immediate
3878 signed displacement.
3879 - ``T``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 20-bit immediate
3880 signed displacement, and an index register.
3881 - ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
3882 - ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
3883 address context evaluates as zero).
3884 - ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
3886 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point register.
3890 - ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3891 - ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
3892 - ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
3893 - ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
3895 - ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
3896 - ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3897 - ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
3898 - ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
3899 - ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
3900 - ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
3901 - ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3902 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
3903 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
3904 - ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3905 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
3906 - ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
3907 - ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
3908 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
3909 - ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
3910 - ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
3911 - ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
3912 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
3913 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
3914 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
3915 - ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
3916 - ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
3917 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
3918 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
3919 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
3920 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
3925 - ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3928 .. _inline-asm-modifiers:
3930 Asm template argument modifiers
3931 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3933 In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
3936 The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3937 GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3938 inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3939 and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3943 - ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
3944 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3945 - ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
3946 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3947 - ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
3948 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3952 - ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
3953 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
3954 - ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
3955 - ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
3956 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
3965 - ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
3969 - ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
3970 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
3971 - ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
3973 - ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
3974 - ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
3975 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
3976 - ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
3977 register of a two-register operand.
3978 - ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
3979 register of a two-register operand.
3980 - ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
3981 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
3984 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
3985 of a two-register operand.
3987 - ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3988 - ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3989 - ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
3994 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3995 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3997 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
3998 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4000 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4001 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4005 No additional modifiers.
4009 - ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
4010 - ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
4011 - ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
4012 - ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
4013 - ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
4014 - ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4015 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
4017 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
4019 - ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4020 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
4022 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
4024 - ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
4025 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
4026 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
4028 - ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this
4029 modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f``
4038 - ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
4039 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
4041 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
4042 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
4044 - ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
4045 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
4046 - ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
4047 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
4048 - ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
4049 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
4050 always print nothing)
4051 - ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
4052 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
4060 SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
4061 target-independent modifiers.
4065 - ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
4066 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
4067 - ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
4068 - ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
4070 - ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
4072 - ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
4074 - ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
4076 - ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
4077 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
4078 - ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
4079 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
4080 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
4081 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
4082 - ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
4083 - ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
4084 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
4088 No additional modifiers.
4094 The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
4095 "``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
4096 integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
4097 location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
4098 error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
4099 errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
4102 .. code-block:: llvm
4104 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
4106 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
4108 It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
4109 in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
4110 will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
4118 LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
4119 that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
4120 code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
4121 debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
4123 Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
4124 ``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
4126 All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
4128 .. _metadata-string:
4130 Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
4131 -----------------------------------
4133 A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
4134 contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
4135 "``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
4138 Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
4139 constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
4140 preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
4141 their operand. For example:
4143 .. code-block:: llvm
4145 !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
4147 Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
4149 .. code-block:: text
4151 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
4153 ``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
4154 content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
4155 when metadata operands change.
4157 A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
4158 metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
4161 .. code-block:: llvm
4165 Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here the ``llvm.dbg.value``
4166 intrinsic is using three metadata arguments:
4168 .. code-block:: llvm
4170 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, metadata !25, metadata !26)
4172 Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached
4173 to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
4175 .. code-block:: llvm
4177 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
4179 Metadata can also be attached to a function or a global variable. Here metadata
4180 ``!22`` is attached to the ``f1`` and ``f2 functions, and the globals ``g1``
4181 and ``g2`` using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
4183 .. code-block:: llvm
4185 declare !dbg !22 void @f1()
4186 define void @f2() !dbg !22 {
4190 @g1 = global i32 0, !dbg !22
4191 @g2 = external global i32, !dbg !22
4193 A transformation is required to drop any metadata attachment that it does not
4194 know or know it can't preserve. Currently there is an exception for metadata
4195 attachment to globals for ``!type`` and ``!absolute_symbol`` which can't be
4196 unconditionally dropped unless the global is itself deleted.
4198 Metadata attached to a module using named metadata may not be dropped, with
4199 the exception of debug metadata (named metadata with the name ``!llvm.dbg.*``).
4201 More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
4202 optimizers and code generator is found below.
4204 .. _specialized-metadata:
4206 Specialized Metadata Nodes
4207 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4209 Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
4210 to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
4213 These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
4214 metadata nodes are related to debug info.
4221 ``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
4222 ``retainedTypes:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:`` fields are tuples
4223 containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile unit, regardless
4224 of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are references to
4225 them from instructions). The ``debugInfoForProfiling:`` field is a boolean
4226 indicating whether or not line-table discriminators are updated to provide
4227 more-accurate debug info for profiling results.
4229 .. code-block:: text
4231 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
4232 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
4233 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: FullDebug,
4234 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, globals: !4, imports: !5,
4235 macros: !6, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
4237 Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
4238 specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope. These
4239 descriptors are collected by a named metadata node ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They keep
4240 track of global variables, type information, and imported entities (declarations
4248 ``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
4250 .. code-block:: none
4252 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir",
4253 checksumkind: CSK_MD5,
4254 checksum: "000102030405060708090a0b0c0d0e0f")
4256 Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
4257 for ``file:`` fields.
4258 Valid values for ``checksumkind:`` field are: {CSK_None, CSK_MD5, CSK_SHA1}
4265 ``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
4266 ``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
4268 .. code-block:: text
4270 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
4271 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
4272 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
4274 The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
4277 .. code-block:: text
4283 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
4285 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
4287 .. _DISubroutineType:
4292 ``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
4293 refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
4294 types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
4295 represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
4297 .. code-block:: text
4299 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
4300 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
4301 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
4308 ``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
4311 .. code-block:: text
4313 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
4314 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
4315 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
4318 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4320 .. code-block:: text
4323 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
4324 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
4326 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
4327 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
4328 DW_TAG_const_type = 38
4330 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
4331 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
4332 DW_TAG_atomic_type = 71
4334 .. _DIDerivedTypeMember:
4336 ``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
4337 <DICompositeType>`. The type of the member is the ``baseType:``. The
4338 ``offset:`` is the member's bit offset. If the composite type has an ODR
4339 ``identifier:`` and does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``, then the member is
4340 uniqued based only on its ``name:`` and ``scope:``.
4342 ``DW_TAG_inheritance`` and ``DW_TAG_friend`` are used in the ``elements:``
4343 field of :ref:`composite types <DICompositeType>` to describe parents and
4346 ``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
4348 ``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
4349 ``DW_TAG_volatile_type``, ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` and ``DW_TAG_atomic_type``
4350 are used to qualify the ``baseType:``.
4352 Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
4354 .. _DICompositeType:
4359 ``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
4360 structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
4362 If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
4363 identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified,
4364 :ref:`subprogram declarations <DISubprogramDeclaration>` and :ref:`member
4365 derived types <DIDerivedTypeMember>` that reference the ODR-type in their
4366 ``scope:`` change uniquing rules.
4368 For a given ``identifier:``, there should only be a single composite type that
4369 does not have ``flags: DIFlagFwdDecl`` set. LLVM tools that link modules
4370 together will unique such definitions at parse time via the ``identifier:``
4371 field, even if the nodes are ``distinct``.
4373 .. code-block:: text
4375 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4376 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4377 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4378 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
4379 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
4380 elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
4382 The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4384 .. code-block:: text
4386 DW_TAG_array_type = 1
4387 DW_TAG_class_type = 2
4388 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
4389 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
4390 DW_TAG_union_type = 23
4392 For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
4393 descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
4394 level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
4395 array type is a native packed vector.
4397 For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
4398 descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
4399 value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
4400 ``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
4402 For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
4403 ``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
4404 <DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member``, ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``, or
4405 ``tag: DW_TAG_friend``; or :ref:`subprograms <DISubprogram>` with
4406 ``isDefinition: false``.
4413 ``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
4414 :ref:`DICompositeType`.
4416 - ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
4417 - ``count: !9`` describes the count with a :ref:`DILocalVariable`.
4418 - ``count: !11`` describes the count with a :ref:`DIGlobalVariable`.
4420 .. code-block:: text
4422 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
4423 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
4424 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
4426 ; Scopes used in rest of example
4427 !6 = !DIFile(filename: "vla.c", directory: "/path/to/file")
4428 !7 = distinct !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !6)
4429 !8 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", scope: !7, file: !6, line: 5)
4431 ; Use of local variable as count value
4432 !9 = !DIBasicType(name: "int", size: 32, encoding: DW_ATE_signed)
4433 !10 = !DILocalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 42, type: !9)
4434 !11 = !DISubrange(count: !10, lowerBound: 0)
4436 ; Use of global variable as count value
4437 !12 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "count", scope: !8, file: !6, line: 22, type: !9)
4438 !13 = !DISubrange(count: !12, lowerBound: 0)
4445 ``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
4446 variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
4448 .. code-block:: text
4450 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4451 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4452 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4454 DITemplateTypeParameter
4455 """""""""""""""""""""""
4457 ``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
4458 language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
4459 :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
4461 .. code-block:: text
4463 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
4465 DITemplateValueParameter
4466 """"""""""""""""""""""""
4468 ``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
4469 language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
4470 but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
4471 ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
4472 :ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
4474 .. code-block:: text
4476 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
4481 ``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
4483 .. code-block:: text
4485 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
4487 .. _DIGlobalVariable:
4492 ``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
4494 .. code-block:: text
4496 !0 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !1,
4497 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
4498 isDefinition: false, variable: i32* @foo,
4501 All global variables should be referenced by the `globals:` field of a
4502 :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
4509 ``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A
4510 ``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using ``!dbg``
4511 metadata. The ``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>`
4512 that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of
4513 the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
4515 .. _DISubprogramDeclaration:
4517 When ``isDefinition: false``, subprograms describe a declaration in the type
4518 tree as opposed to a definition of a function. If the scope is a composite
4519 type with an ODR ``identifier:`` and that does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``,
4520 then the subprogram declaration is uniqued based only on its ``linkageName:``
4523 .. code-block:: text
4525 define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
4529 !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
4530 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
4531 isDefinition: true, scopeLine: 8,
4533 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
4534 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
4535 isOptimized: true, unit: !5, templateParams: !6,
4536 declaration: !7, variables: !8, thrownTypes: !9)
4543 ``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
4544 <DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
4545 two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
4548 .. code-block:: text
4550 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
4552 Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
4555 .. _DILexicalBlockFile:
4560 ``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
4561 :ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
4562 indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
4563 discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
4565 .. code-block:: text
4567 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
4568 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
4569 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
4576 ``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
4577 mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
4578 :ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
4580 .. code-block:: text
4582 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
4584 .. _DILocalVariable:
4589 ``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
4590 the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
4591 parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its
4592 :ref:`DISubprogram`.
4594 .. code-block:: text
4596 !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
4597 type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
4598 !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
4600 !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
4605 ``DIExpression`` nodes represent expressions that are inspired by the DWARF
4606 expression language. They are used in :ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>`
4607 (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare`` and ``llvm.dbg.value``) to describe how the
4608 referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language variable. Debug
4609 intrinsics are interpreted left-to-right: start by pushing the value/address
4610 operand of the intrinsic onto a stack, then repeatedly push and evaluate
4611 opcodes from the DIExpression until the final variable description is produced.
4613 The current supported opcode vocabulary is limited:
4615 - ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the top of the expression stack.
4616 - ``DW_OP_plus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, adds
4617 them together and appends the result to the expression stack.
4618 - ``DW_OP_minus`` pops the last two entries from the expression stack, subtracts
4619 the last entry from the second last entry and appends the result to the
4621 - ``DW_OP_plus_uconst, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
4622 - ``DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
4623 here, respectively) of the variable fragment from the working expression. Note
4624 that contrary to DW_OP_bit_piece, the offset is describing the location
4625 within the described source variable.
4626 - ``DW_OP_swap`` swaps top two stack entries.
4627 - ``DW_OP_xderef`` provides extended dereference mechanism. The entry at the top
4628 of the stack is treated as an address. The second stack entry is treated as an
4629 address space identifier.
4630 - ``DW_OP_stack_value`` marks a constant value.
4632 DWARF specifies three kinds of simple location descriptions: Register, memory,
4633 and implicit location descriptions. Note that a location description is
4634 defined over certain ranges of a program, i.e the location of a variable may
4635 change over the course of the program. Register and memory location
4636 descriptions describe the *concrete location* of a source variable (in the
4637 sense that a debugger might modify its value), whereas *implicit locations*
4638 describe merely the actual *value* of a source variable which might not exist
4639 in registers or in memory (see ``DW_OP_stack_value``).
4641 A ``llvm.dbg.addr`` or ``llvm.dbg.declare`` intrinsic describes an indirect
4642 value (the address) of a source variable. The first operand of the intrinsic
4643 must be an address of some kind. A DIExpression attached to the intrinsic
4644 refines this address to produce a concrete location for the source variable.
4646 A ``llvm.dbg.value`` intrinsic describes the direct value of a source variable.
4647 The first operand of the intrinsic may be a direct or indirect value. A
4648 DIExpresion attached to the intrinsic refines the first operand to produce a
4649 direct value. For example, if the first operand is an indirect value, it may be
4650 necessary to insert ``DW_OP_deref`` into the DIExpresion in order to produce a
4651 valid debug intrinsic.
4655 A DIExpression is interpreted in the same way regardless of which kind of
4656 debug intrinsic it's attached to.
4658 .. code-block:: text
4660 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
4661 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus_uconst, 3)
4662 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus)
4663 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
4664 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_constu, 3, DW_OP_plus, DW_OP_LLVM_fragment, 3, 7)
4665 !4 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 2, DW_OP_swap, DW_OP_xderef)
4666 !5 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_constu, 42, DW_OP_stack_value)
4671 ``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
4673 .. code-block:: text
4675 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
4676 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
4681 ``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
4684 .. code-block:: text
4686 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
4687 entity: !1, line: 7)
4692 ``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
4693 The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
4694 defining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string
4695 used to expand the macro identifier.
4697 .. code-block:: text
4699 !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
4701 !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
4706 ``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files.
4707 The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that
4708 appear in the included source file.
4710 .. code-block:: text
4712 !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
4718 In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
4719 suitable for doing type based alias analysis (TBAA). Instead, metadata is
4720 added to the IR to describe a type system of a higher level language. This
4721 can be used to implement C/C++ strict type aliasing rules, but it can also
4722 be used to implement custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
4724 This description of LLVM's TBAA system is broken into two parts:
4725 :ref:`Semantics<tbaa_node_semantics>` talks about high level issues, and
4726 :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` talks about the metadata
4727 encoding of various entities.
4729 It is always possible to trace any TBAA node to a "root" TBAA node (details
4730 in the :ref:`Representation<tbaa_node_representation>` section). TBAA
4731 nodes with different roots have an unknown aliasing relationship, and LLVM
4732 conservatively infers ``MayAlias`` between them. The rules mentioned in
4733 this section only pertain to TBAA nodes living under the same root.
4735 .. _tbaa_node_semantics:
4740 The TBAA metadata system, referred to as "struct path TBAA" (not to be
4741 confused with ``tbaa.struct``), consists of the following high level
4742 concepts: *Type Descriptors*, further subdivided into scalar type
4743 descriptors and struct type descriptors; and *Access Tags*.
4745 **Type descriptors** describe the type system of the higher level language
4746 being compiled. **Scalar type descriptors** describe types that do not
4747 contain other types. Each scalar type has a parent type, which must also
4748 be a scalar type or the TBAA root. Via this parent relation, scalar types
4749 within a TBAA root form a tree. **Struct type descriptors** denote types
4750 that contain a sequence of other type descriptors, at known offsets. These
4751 contained type descriptors can either be struct type descriptors themselves
4752 or scalar type descriptors.
4754 **Access tags** are metadata nodes attached to load and store instructions.
4755 Access tags use type descriptors to describe the *location* being accessed
4756 in terms of the type system of the higher level language. Access tags are
4757 tuples consisting of a base type, an access type and an offset. The base
4758 type is a scalar type descriptor or a struct type descriptor, the access
4759 type is a scalar type descriptor, and the offset is a constant integer.
4761 The access tag ``(BaseTy, AccessTy, Offset)`` can describe one of two
4764 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type, the tag describes a memory access (load
4765 or store) of a value of type ``AccessTy`` contained in the struct type
4766 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset``.
4768 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type, ``Offset`` must be 0 and ``BaseTy`` and
4769 ``AccessTy`` must be the same; and the access tag describes a scalar
4770 access with scalar type ``AccessTy``.
4772 We first define an ``ImmediateParent`` relation on ``(BaseTy, Offset)``
4775 * If ``BaseTy`` is a scalar type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, 0)`` is
4776 ``(ParentTy, 0)`` where ``ParentTy`` is the parent of the scalar type as
4777 described in the TBAA metadata. ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)`` is
4778 undefined if ``Offset`` is non-zero.
4780 * If ``BaseTy`` is a struct type then ``ImmediateParent(BaseTy, Offset)``
4781 is ``(NewTy, NewOffset)`` where ``NewTy`` is the type contained in
4782 ``BaseTy`` at offset ``Offset`` and ``NewOffset`` is ``Offset`` adjusted
4783 to be relative within that inner type.
4785 A memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy1, AccessTy1, Offset1)``
4786 aliases a memory access with an access tag ``(BaseTy2, AccessTy2,
4787 Offset2)`` if either ``(BaseTy1, Offset1)`` is reachable from ``(Base2,
4788 Offset2)`` via the ``Parent`` relation or vice versa.
4790 As a concrete example, the type descriptor graph for the following program
4796 float f; // offset 4
4800 float f; // offset 0
4801 double d; // offset 4
4802 struct Inner inner_a; // offset 12
4805 void f(struct Outer* outer, struct Inner* inner, float* f, int* i, char* c) {
4806 outer->f = 0; // tag0: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4807 outer->inner_a.i = 0; // tag1: (OuterStructTy, IntScalarTy, 12)
4808 outer->inner_a.f = 0.0; // tag2: (OuterStructTy, FloatScalarTy, 16)
4809 *f = 0.0; // tag3: (FloatScalarTy, FloatScalarTy, 0)
4812 is (note that in C and C++, ``char`` can be used to access any arbitrary
4815 .. code-block:: text
4818 CharScalarTy = ("char", Root, 0)
4819 FloatScalarTy = ("float", CharScalarTy, 0)
4820 DoubleScalarTy = ("double", CharScalarTy, 0)
4821 IntScalarTy = ("int", CharScalarTy, 0)
4822 InnerStructTy = {"Inner" (IntScalarTy, 0), (FloatScalarTy, 4)}
4823 OuterStructTy = {"Outer", (FloatScalarTy, 0), (DoubleScalarTy, 4),
4824 (InnerStructTy, 12)}
4827 with (e.g.) ``ImmediateParent(OuterStructTy, 12)`` = ``(InnerStructTy,
4828 0)``, ``ImmediateParent(InnerStructTy, 0)`` = ``(IntScalarTy, 0)``, and
4829 ``ImmediateParent(IntScalarTy, 0)`` = ``(CharScalarTy, 0)``.
4831 .. _tbaa_node_representation:
4836 The root node of a TBAA type hierarchy is an ``MDNode`` with 0 operands or
4837 with exactly one ``MDString`` operand.
4839 Scalar type descriptors are represented as an ``MDNode`` s with two
4840 operands. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting the name of the
4841 struct type. LLVM does not assign meaning to the value of this operand, it
4842 only cares about it being an ``MDString``. The second operand is an
4843 ``MDNode`` which points to the parent for said scalar type descriptor,
4844 which is either another scalar type descriptor or the TBAA root. Scalar
4845 type descriptors can have an optional third argument, but that must be the
4846 constant integer zero.
4848 Struct type descriptors are represented as ``MDNode`` s with an odd number
4849 of operands greater than 1. The first operand is an ``MDString`` denoting
4850 the name of the struct type. Like in scalar type descriptors the actual
4851 value of this name operand is irrelevant to LLVM. After the name operand,
4852 the struct type descriptors have a sequence of alternating ``MDNode`` and
4853 ``ConstantInt`` operands. With N starting from 1, the 2N - 1 th operand,
4854 an ``MDNode``, denotes a contained field, and the 2N th operand, a
4855 ``ConstantInt``, is the offset of the said contained field. The offsets
4856 must be in non-decreasing order.
4858 Access tags are represented as ``MDNode`` s with either 3 or 4 operands.
4859 The first operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node representing the
4860 base type. The second operand is an ``MDNode`` pointing to the node
4861 representing the access type. The third operand is a ``ConstantInt`` that
4862 states the offset of the access. If a fourth field is present, it must be
4863 a ``ConstantInt`` valued at 0 or 1. If it is 1 then the access tag states
4864 that the location being accessed is "constant" (meaning
4865 ``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
4866 AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_). The TBAA root of
4867 the access type and the base type of an access tag must be the same, and
4868 that is the TBAA root of the access tag.
4870 '``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
4871 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4873 The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
4874 aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
4875 is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
4876 strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
4877 padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
4880 ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
4881 memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
4883 The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
4884 nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
4885 For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
4886 field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
4889 .. code-block:: llvm
4891 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
4893 This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
4894 with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
4895 and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
4897 Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
4898 4 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
4899 does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
4901 '``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
4902 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4904 ``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
4905 noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
4906 instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
4907 ``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
4908 collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
4909 Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
4912 When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
4913 of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
4914 subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
4915 instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
4918 Because scopes in one domain don't affect scopes in other domains, separate
4919 domains can be used to compose multiple independent noalias sets. This is
4920 used for example during inlining. As the noalias function parameters are
4921 turned into noalias scope metadata, a new domain is used every time the
4922 function is inlined.
4924 The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
4925 entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
4926 string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
4927 self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
4928 descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
4930 The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
4931 three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
4932 is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
4933 self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
4934 reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
4935 optionally be provided as a third list entry.
4939 .. code-block:: llvm
4941 ; Two scope domains:
4945 ; Some scopes in these domains:
4951 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
4955 ; These two instructions don't alias:
4956 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
4957 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
4959 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
4960 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
4961 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
4962 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
4964 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
4965 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
4966 ; !alias.scope list):
4967 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
4968 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
4970 '``fpmath``' Metadata
4971 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4973 ``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating-point
4974 type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
4975 result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
4976 compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
4977 it. ULP is defined as follows:
4979 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
4980 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
4981 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
4982 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
4983 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
4985 The metadata node shall consist of a single positive float type number
4986 representing the maximum relative error, for example:
4988 .. code-block:: llvm
4990 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
4994 '``range``' Metadata
4995 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4997 ``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
4998 integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
4999 returned by the called function at this call site is in. If the loaded or
5000 returned value is not in the specified range, the behavior is undefined. The
5001 ranges are represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or
5002 the value returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each
5003 consecutive pair. Each pair has the following properties:
5005 - The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
5006 - The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
5007 - Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
5008 - The range is allowed to wrap.
5009 - The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
5012 In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
5013 they must be non-contiguous.
5017 .. code-block:: llvm
5019 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
5020 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
5021 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
5022 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
5023 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
5025 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
5026 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
5027 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
5028 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
5030 '``absolute_symbol``' Metadata
5031 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5033 ``absolute_symbol`` metadata may be attached to a global variable
5034 declaration. It marks the declaration as a reference to an absolute symbol,
5035 which causes the backend to use absolute relocations for the symbol even
5036 in position independent code, and expresses the possible ranges that the
5037 global variable's *address* (not its value) is in, in the same format as
5038 ``range`` metadata, with the extension that the pair ``all-ones,all-ones``
5039 may be used to represent the full set.
5041 Example (assuming 64-bit pointers):
5043 .. code-block:: llvm
5045 @a = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !0 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,256)
5046 @b = external global i8, !absolute_symbol !1 ; Absolute symbol in range [0,2^64)
5049 !0 = !{ i64 0, i64 256 }
5050 !1 = !{ i64 -1, i64 -1 }
5052 '``callees``' Metadata
5053 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5055 ``callees`` metadata may be attached to indirect call sites. If ``callees``
5056 metadata is attached to a call site, and any callee is not among the set of
5057 functions provided by the metadata, the behavior is undefined. The intent of
5058 this metadata is to facilitate optimizations such as indirect-call promotion.
5059 For example, in the code below, the call instruction may only target the
5060 ``add`` or ``sub`` functions:
5062 .. code-block:: llvm
5064 %result = call i64 %binop(i64 %x, i64 %y), !callees !0
5067 !0 = !{i64 (i64, i64)* @add, i64 (i64, i64)* @sub}
5069 '``unpredictable``' Metadata
5070 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5072 ``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
5073 instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
5074 flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
5075 optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
5076 is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
5077 or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
5082 It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
5083 loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
5084 in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
5085 guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
5086 specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
5088 The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
5089 itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
5090 during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
5091 to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
5092 The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
5095 .. code-block:: llvm
5100 The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
5101 per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
5102 as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
5103 suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
5105 .. code-block:: llvm
5107 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
5110 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
5112 '``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
5113 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5115 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
5116 used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
5117 vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
5118 conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
5119 ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
5120 optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
5121 it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata
5122 which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
5123 in determining the safety of these transformations.
5125 '``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
5126 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5128 This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
5129 The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
5130 second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
5133 .. code-block:: llvm
5135 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
5137 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
5138 multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
5139 then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
5141 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
5142 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5144 This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
5145 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
5146 is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
5147 0 disables vectorization:
5149 .. code-block:: llvm
5151 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
5152 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
5154 '``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
5155 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5157 This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
5158 operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
5159 operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
5161 .. code-block:: llvm
5163 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
5165 Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
5166 vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
5167 0 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
5168 determined automatically.
5170 '``llvm.loop.unroll``'
5171 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5173 Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
5174 optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
5175 metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5176 identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
5177 optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
5178 optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
5180 '``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
5181 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5183 This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
5184 first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
5185 operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
5188 .. code-block:: llvm
5190 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
5192 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5193 will be partially unrolled.
5195 '``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
5196 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5198 This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
5199 which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
5201 .. code-block:: llvm
5203 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
5205 '``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
5206 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5208 This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
5209 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
5211 .. code-block:: llvm
5213 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
5215 '``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata
5216 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5218 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
5219 is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
5220 at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
5221 ``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. For example:
5223 .. code-block:: llvm
5225 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
5227 '``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
5228 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5230 This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
5231 metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
5234 .. code-block:: llvm
5236 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
5238 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam``'
5239 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5241 This metadata is treated very similarly to the ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata
5242 above, but affect the unroll and jam pass. In addition any loop with
5243 ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata but no ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam`` metadata will
5244 disable unroll and jam (so ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata will be left to the
5245 unroller, plus ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable`` metadata will disable unroll and jam
5248 The metadata for unroll and jam otherwise is the same as for ``unroll``.
5249 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``, ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable`` and
5250 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count`` do the same as for unroll.
5251 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.full`` is not supported. Again these are only hints
5252 and the normal safety checks will still be performed.
5254 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count``' Metadata
5255 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5257 This metadata suggests an unroll and jam factor to use, similarly to
5258 ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``. The first operand is the string
5259 ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count`` and the second operand is a positive integer
5260 specifying the unroll factor. For example:
5262 .. code-block:: llvm
5264 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.count", i32 4}
5266 If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
5267 will be partially unroll and jammed.
5269 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable``' Metadata
5270 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5272 This metadata disables loop unroll and jamming. The metadata has a single
5273 operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable``. For example:
5275 .. code-block:: llvm
5277 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.disable"}
5279 '``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``' Metadata
5280 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5282 This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unroll and jammed if the
5283 trip count is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is
5284 not known at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the
5285 string ``llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable``. For example:
5287 .. code-block:: llvm
5289 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll_and_jam.enable"}
5291 '``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``' Metadata
5292 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5294 This metadata indicates that the loop should not be versioned for the purpose
5295 of enabling loop-invariant code motion (LICM). The metadata has a single operand
5296 which is the string ``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``. For example:
5298 .. code-block:: llvm
5300 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable"}
5302 '``llvm.loop.distribute.enable``' Metadata
5303 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5305 Loop distribution allows splitting a loop into multiple loops. Currently,
5306 this is only performed if the entire loop cannot be vectorized due to unsafe
5307 memory dependencies. The transformation will attempt to isolate the unsafe
5308 dependencies into their own loop.
5310 This metadata can be used to selectively enable or disable distribution of the
5311 loop. The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.distribute.enable`` and the
5312 second operand is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 distribution is
5313 enabled. A value of 0 disables distribution:
5315 .. code-block:: llvm
5317 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 0}
5318 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 1}
5320 This metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
5321 identification metadata.
5326 Metadata types used to annotate memory accesses with information helpful
5327 for optimizations are prefixed with ``llvm.mem``.
5329 '``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``' Metadata
5330 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5332 The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata refers to a loop identifier,
5333 or metadata containing a list of loop identifiers for nested loops.
5334 The metadata is attached to memory accessing instructions and denotes that
5335 no loop carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions denoted
5336 with the same loop identifier. The metadata on memory reads also implies that
5337 if conversion (i.e. speculative execution within a loop iteration) is safe.
5339 Precisely, given two instructions ``m1`` and ``m2`` that both have the
5340 ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata, with ``L1`` and ``L2`` being the
5341 set of loops associated with that metadata, respectively, then there is no loop
5342 carried dependence between ``m1`` and ``m2`` for loops in both ``L1`` and
5345 As a special case, if all memory accessing instructions in a loop have
5346 ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
5347 loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a parallel
5350 Note that if not all memory access instructions have such metadata referring to
5351 the loop, then the loop is considered not being trivially parallel. Additional
5352 memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
5353 safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
5354 sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
5355 insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
5357 Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
5358 both ``llvm.loop`` and ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``
5359 metadata types that refer to the same loop identifier metadata.
5361 .. code-block:: llvm
5365 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
5367 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
5369 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
5375 It is also possible to have nested parallel loops. In that case the
5376 memory accesses refer to a list of loop identifier metadata nodes instead of
5377 the loop identifier metadata node directly:
5379 .. code-block:: llvm
5383 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
5385 br label %inner.for.body
5389 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
5391 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
5393 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
5397 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
5399 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
5401 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
5403 !0 = !{!1, !2} ; a list of loop identifiers
5404 !1 = !{!1} ; an identifier for the inner loop
5405 !2 = !{!2} ; an identifier for the outer loop
5407 '``irr_loop``' Metadata
5408 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5410 ``irr_loop`` metadata may be attached to the terminator instruction of a basic
5411 block that's an irreducible loop header (note that an irreducible loop has more
5412 than once header basic blocks.) If ``irr_loop`` metadata is attached to the
5413 terminator instruction of a basic block that is not really an irreducible loop
5414 header, the behavior is undefined. The intent of this metadata is to improve the
5415 accuracy of the block frequency propagation. For example, in the code below, the
5416 block ``header0`` may have a loop header weight (relative to the other headers of
5417 the irreducible loop) of 100:
5419 .. code-block:: llvm
5423 br i1 %cmp, label %t1, label %t2, !irr_loop !0
5426 !0 = !{"loop_header_weight", i64 100}
5428 Irreducible loop header weights are typically based on profile data.
5430 '``invariant.group``' Metadata
5431 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5433 The experimental ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to
5434 ``load``/``store`` instructions referencing a single metadata with no entries.
5435 The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells
5436 the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand
5437 can be assumed to load or store the same
5438 value (but see the ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` intrinsic which affects
5439 when two pointers are considered the same). Pointers returned by bitcast or
5440 getelementptr with only zero indices are considered the same.
5444 .. code-block:: llvm
5446 @unknownPtr = external global i8
5449 store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
5450 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5452 %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
5453 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5455 %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr)
5456 %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
5458 %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
5459 store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
5461 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
5462 %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8* %ptr)
5463 %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through launder.invariant.group to get value of %ptr
5466 declare void @foo(i8*)
5467 declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
5468 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group(i8*)
5472 The invariant.group metadata must be dropped when replacing one pointer by
5473 another based on aliasing information. This is because invariant.group is tied
5474 to the SSA value of the pointer operand.
5476 .. code-block:: llvm
5478 %v = load i8, i8* %x, !invariant.group !0
5479 ; if %x mustalias %y then we can replace the above instruction with
5480 %v = load i8, i8* %y
5482 Note that this is an experimental feature, which means that its semantics might
5483 change in the future.
5488 See :doc:`TypeMetadata`.
5490 '``associated``' Metadata
5491 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5493 The ``associated`` metadata may be attached to a global object
5494 declaration with a single argument that references another global object.
5496 This metadata prevents discarding of the global object in linker GC
5497 unless the referenced object is also discarded. The linker support for
5498 this feature is spotty. For best compatibility, globals carrying this
5501 - Be in a comdat with the referenced global.
5502 - Be in @llvm.compiler.used.
5503 - Have an explicit section with a name which is a valid C identifier.
5505 It does not have any effect on non-ELF targets.
5509 .. code-block:: text
5512 @a = global i32 1, comdat $a
5513 @b = internal global i32 2, comdat $a, section "abc", !associated !0
5520 The ``prof`` metadata is used to record profile data in the IR.
5521 The first operand of the metadata node indicates the profile metadata
5522 type. There are currently 3 types:
5523 :ref:`branch_weights<prof_node_branch_weights>`,
5524 :ref:`function_entry_count<prof_node_function_entry_count>`, and
5525 :ref:`VP<prof_node_VP>`.
5527 .. _prof_node_branch_weights:
5532 Branch weight metadata attached to a branch, select, switch or call instruction
5533 represents the likeliness of the associated branch being taken.
5534 For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5536 .. _prof_node_function_entry_count:
5538 function_entry_count
5539 """"""""""""""""""""
5541 Function entry count metadata can be attached to function definitions
5542 to record the number of times the function is called. Used with BFI
5543 information, it is also used to derive the basic block profile count.
5544 For more information, see :doc:`BranchWeightMetadata`.
5551 VP (value profile) metadata can be attached to instructions that have
5552 value profile information. Currently this is indirect calls (where it
5553 records the hottest callees) and calls to memory intrinsics such as memcpy,
5554 memmove, and memset (where it records the hottest byte lengths).
5556 Each VP metadata node contains "VP" string, then a uint32_t value for the value
5557 profiling kind, a uint64_t value for the total number of times the instruction
5558 is executed, followed by uint64_t value and execution count pairs.
5559 The value profiling kind is 0 for indirect call targets and 1 for memory
5560 operations. For indirect call targets, each profile value is a hash
5561 of the callee function name, and for memory operations each value is the
5564 Note that the value counts do not need to add up to the total count
5565 listed in the third operand (in practice only the top hottest values
5566 are tracked and reported).
5568 Indirect call example:
5570 .. code-block:: llvm
5572 call void %f(), !prof !1
5573 !1 = !{!"VP", i32 0, i64 1600, i64 7651369219802541373, i64 1030, i64 -4377547752858689819, i64 410}
5575 Note that the VP type is 0 (the second operand), which indicates this is
5576 an indirect call value profile data. The third operand indicates that the
5577 indirect call executed 1600 times. The 4th and 6th operands give the
5578 hashes of the 2 hottest target functions' names (this is the same hash used
5579 to represent function names in the profile database), and the 5th and 7th
5580 operands give the execution count that each of the respective prior target
5581 functions was called.
5583 Module Flags Metadata
5584 =====================
5586 Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
5587 subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
5588 The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
5589 this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
5590 dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
5593 The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
5594 Each triplet has the following form:
5596 - The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
5597 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
5598 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
5600 - The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
5601 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
5602 including entries with the **Require** behavior).
5603 - The third element is the value of the flag.
5605 When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
5606 ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
5607 each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
5608 modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
5609 be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
5610 is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
5612 The following behaviors are supported:
5623 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
5624 is that of the operands.
5628 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
5629 operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
5633 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
5634 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
5635 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
5636 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
5637 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
5638 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
5639 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
5643 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
5644 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
5645 differ, an error will be emitted.
5649 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
5653 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
5654 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
5655 during the append operation.
5659 Takes the max of the two values, which are required to be integers.
5661 It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
5662 except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
5663 value) or **Override**.
5665 An example of module flags:
5667 .. code-block:: llvm
5669 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
5670 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
5671 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
5672 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
5677 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
5679 - Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
5680 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
5681 values are not equal.
5683 - Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
5684 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
5687 - Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
5688 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
5689 warning if their values are not equal.
5691 - Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
5697 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
5698 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
5701 Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
5702 ----------------------------------------------------
5704 On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
5705 collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
5706 consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
5707 garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
5708 modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
5709 be merged rather than appended together.
5711 The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
5712 following key-value pairs:
5721 * - ``Objective-C Version``
5722 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
5724 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
5725 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
5728 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
5729 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
5730 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
5731 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
5732 Objective-C ABI version 2.
5734 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
5735 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
5736 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
5737 collection supported.
5739 * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
5740 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
5741 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
5742 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
5744 Some important flag interactions:
5746 - If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
5747 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
5748 2, then the resulting module has the
5749 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
5750 - A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
5751 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
5753 C type width Module Flags Metadata
5754 ----------------------------------
5756 The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
5757 options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
5758 linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
5759 of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
5762 To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
5763 flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
5773 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
5774 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
5777 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
5778 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
5779 represent all of its values.
5781 For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
5782 compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
5783 enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
5785 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
5786 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
5787 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
5789 Automatic Linker Flags Named Metadata
5790 =====================================
5792 Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object
5793 files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
5794 allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have
5795 these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
5797 These flags are encoded in the IR using named metadata with the name
5798 ``!llvm.linker.options``. Each operand is expected to be a metadata node
5799 which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
5800 list of metadata strings defining linker options.
5802 For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
5803 linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
5807 !1 = !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } }
5808 !llvm.linker.options = !{ !0, !1 }
5810 The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
5811 list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
5812 strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
5813 preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
5814 assembly writer or object file emitter.
5816 Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
5817 linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
5818 object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
5825 Compiling with `ThinLTO <https://clang.llvm.org/docs/ThinLTO.html>`_
5826 causes the building of a compact summary of the module that is emitted into
5827 the bitcode. The summary is emitted into the LLVM assembly and identified
5828 in syntax by a caret ('``^``').
5830 The summary is parsed into a bitcode output, along with the Module
5831 IR, via the "``llvm-as``" tool. Tools that parse the Module IR for the purposes
5832 of optimization (e.g. "``clang -x ir``" and "``opt``"), will ignore the
5833 summary entries (just as they currently ignore summary entries in a bitcode
5836 Eventually, the summary will be parsed into a ModuleSummaryIndex object under
5837 the same conditions where summary index is currently built from bitcode.
5838 Specifically, tools that test the Thin Link portion of a ThinLTO compile
5839 (i.e. llvm-lto and llvm-lto2), or when parsing a combined index
5840 for a distributed ThinLTO backend via clang's "``-fthinlto-index=<>``" flag
5841 (this part is not yet implemented, use llvm-as to create a bitcode object
5842 before feeding into thin link tools for now).
5844 There are currently 3 types of summary entries in the LLVM assembly:
5845 :ref:`module paths<module_path_summary>`,
5846 :ref:`global values<gv_summary>`, and
5847 :ref:`type identifiers<typeid_summary>`.
5849 .. _module_path_summary:
5851 Module Path Summary Entry
5852 -------------------------
5854 Each module path summary entry lists a module containing global values included
5855 in the summary. For a single IR module there will be one such entry, but
5856 in a combined summary index produced during the thin link, there will be
5857 one module path entry per linked module with summary.
5861 .. code-block:: text
5863 ^0 = module: (path: "/path/to/file.o", hash: (2468601609, 1329373163, 1565878005, 638838075, 3148790418))
5865 The ``path`` field is a string path to the bitcode file, and the ``hash``
5866 field is the 160-bit SHA-1 hash of the IR bitcode contents, used for
5867 incremental builds and caching.
5871 Global Value Summary Entry
5872 --------------------------
5874 Each global value summary entry corresponds to a global value defined or
5875 referenced by a summarized module.
5879 .. code-block:: text
5881 ^4 = gv: (name: "f"[, summaries: (Summary)[, (Summary)]*]?) ; guid = 14740650423002898831
5883 For declarations, there will not be a summary list. For definitions, a
5884 global value will contain a list of summaries, one per module containing
5885 a definition. There can be multiple entries in a combined summary index
5886 for symbols with weak linkage.
5888 Each ``Summary`` format will depend on whether the global value is a
5889 :ref:`function<function_summary>`, :ref:`variable<variable_summary>`, or
5890 :ref:`alias<alias_summary>`.
5892 .. _function_summary:
5897 If the global value is a function, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
5899 .. code-block:: text
5901 function: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0), insts: 2[, FuncFlags]?[, Calls]?[, TypeIdInfo]?[, Refs]?
5903 The ``module`` field includes the summary entry id for the module containing
5904 this definition, and the ``flags`` field contains information such as
5905 the linkage type, a flag indicating whether it is legal to import the
5906 definition, whether it is globally live and whether the linker resolved it
5907 to a local definition (the latter two are populated during the thin link).
5908 The ``insts`` field contains the number of IR instructions in the function.
5909 Finally, there are several optional fields: :ref:`FuncFlags<funcflags_summary>`,
5910 :ref:`Calls<calls_summary>`, :ref:`TypeIdInfo<typeidinfo_summary>`,
5911 :ref:`Refs<refs_summary>`.
5913 .. _variable_summary:
5915 Global Variable Summary
5916 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5918 If the global value is a variable, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
5920 .. code-block:: text
5922 variable: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0)[, Refs]?
5924 The variable entry contains a subset of the fields in a
5925 :ref:`function summary <function_summary>`, see the descriptions there.
5932 If the global value is an alias, the ``Summary`` entry will look like:
5934 .. code-block:: text
5936 alias: (module: ^0, flags: (linkage: external, notEligibleToImport: 0, live: 0, dsoLocal: 0), aliasee: ^2)
5938 The ``module`` and ``flags`` fields are as described for a
5939 :ref:`function summary <function_summary>`. The ``aliasee`` field
5940 contains a reference to the global value summary entry of the aliasee.
5942 .. _funcflags_summary:
5947 The optional ``FuncFlags`` field looks like:
5949 .. code-block:: text
5951 funcFlags: (readNone: 0, readOnly: 0, noRecurse: 0, returnDoesNotAlias: 0)
5953 If unspecified, flags are assumed to hold the conservative ``false`` value of
5961 The optional ``Calls`` field looks like:
5963 .. code-block:: text
5965 calls: ((Callee)[, (Callee)]*)
5967 where each ``Callee`` looks like:
5969 .. code-block:: text
5971 callee: ^1[, hotness: None]?[, relbf: 0]?
5973 The ``callee`` refers to the summary entry id of the callee. At most one
5974 of ``hotness`` (which can take the values ``Unknown``, ``Cold``, ``None``,
5975 ``Hot``, and ``Critical``), and ``relbf`` (which holds the integer
5976 branch frequency relative to the entry frequency, scaled down by 2^8)
5977 may be specified. The defaults are ``Unknown`` and ``0``, respectively.
5984 The optional ``Refs`` field looks like:
5986 .. code-block:: text
5988 refs: ((Ref)[, (Ref)]*)
5990 where each ``Ref`` contains a reference to the summary id of the referenced
5991 value (e.g. ``^1``).
5993 .. _typeidinfo_summary:
5998 The optional ``TypeIdInfo`` field, used for
5999 `Control Flow Integrity <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/ControlFlowIntegrity.html>`_,
6002 .. code-block:: text
6004 typeIdInfo: [(TypeTests)]?[, (TypeTestAssumeVCalls)]?[, (TypeCheckedLoadVCalls)]?[, (TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls)]?[, (TypeCheckedLoadConstVCalls)]?
6006 These optional fields have the following forms:
6011 .. code-block:: text
6013 typeTests: (TypeIdRef[, TypeIdRef]*)
6015 Where each ``TypeIdRef`` refers to a :ref:`type id<typeid_summary>`
6016 by summary id or ``GUID``.
6018 TypeTestAssumeVCalls
6019 """"""""""""""""""""
6021 .. code-block:: text
6023 typeTestAssumeVCalls: (VFuncId[, VFuncId]*)
6025 Where each VFuncId has the format:
6027 .. code-block:: text
6029 vFuncId: (TypeIdRef, offset: 16)
6031 Where each ``TypeIdRef`` refers to a :ref:`type id<typeid_summary>`
6032 by summary id or ``GUID`` preceeded by a ``guid:`` tag.
6034 TypeCheckedLoadVCalls
6035 """""""""""""""""""""
6037 .. code-block:: text
6039 typeCheckedLoadVCalls: (VFuncId[, VFuncId]*)
6041 Where each VFuncId has the format described for ``TypeTestAssumeVCalls``.
6043 TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls
6044 """""""""""""""""""""""""
6046 .. code-block:: text
6048 typeTestAssumeConstVCalls: (ConstVCall[, ConstVCall]*)
6050 Where each ConstVCall has the format:
6052 .. code-block:: text
6054 (VFuncId, args: (Arg[, Arg]*))
6056 and where each VFuncId has the format described for ``TypeTestAssumeVCalls``,
6057 and each Arg is an integer argument number.
6059 TypeCheckedLoadConstVCalls
6060 """"""""""""""""""""""""""
6062 .. code-block:: text
6064 typeCheckedLoadConstVCalls: (ConstVCall[, ConstVCall]*)
6066 Where each ConstVCall has the format described for
6067 ``TypeTestAssumeConstVCalls``.
6071 Type ID Summary Entry
6072 ---------------------
6074 Each type id summary entry corresponds to a type identifier resolution
6075 which is generated during the LTO link portion of the compile when building
6076 with `Control Flow Integrity <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/ControlFlowIntegrity.html>`_,
6077 so these are only present in a combined summary index.
6081 .. code-block:: text
6083 ^4 = typeid: (name: "_ZTS1A", summary: (typeTestRes: (kind: allOnes, sizeM1BitWidth: 7[, alignLog2: 0]?[, sizeM1: 0]?[, bitMask: 0]?[, inlineBits: 0]?)[, WpdResolutions]?)) ; guid = 7004155349499253778
6085 The ``typeTestRes`` gives the type test resolution ``kind`` (which may
6086 be ``unsat``, ``byteArray``, ``inline``, ``single``, or ``allOnes``), and
6087 the ``size-1`` bit width. It is followed by optional flags, which default to 0,
6088 and an optional WpdResolutions (whole program devirtualization resolution)
6089 field that looks like:
6091 .. code-block:: text
6093 wpdResolutions: ((offset: 0, WpdRes)[, (offset: 1, WpdRes)]*
6095 where each entry is a mapping from the given byte offset to the whole-program
6096 devirtualization resolution WpdRes, that has one of the following formats:
6098 .. code-block:: text
6100 wpdRes: (kind: branchFunnel)
6101 wpdRes: (kind: singleImpl, singleImplName: "_ZN1A1nEi")
6102 wpdRes: (kind: indir)
6104 Additionally, each wpdRes has an optional ``resByArg`` field, which
6105 describes the resolutions for calls with all constant integer arguments:
6107 .. code-block:: text
6109 resByArg: (ResByArg[, ResByArg]*)
6113 .. code-block:: text
6115 args: (Arg[, Arg]*), byArg: (kind: UniformRetVal[, info: 0][, byte: 0][, bit: 0])
6117 Where the ``kind`` can be ``Indir``, ``UniformRetVal``, ``UniqueRetVal``
6118 or ``VirtualConstProp``. The ``info`` field is only used if the kind
6119 is ``UniformRetVal`` (indicates the uniform return value), or
6120 ``UniqueRetVal`` (holds the return value associated with the unique vtable
6121 (0 or 1)). The ``byte`` and ``bit`` fields are only used if the target does
6122 not support the use of absolute symbols to store constants.
6124 .. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
6126 Intrinsic Global Variables
6127 ==========================
6129 LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
6130 affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
6131 All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
6132 "``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
6133 "``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
6137 The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
6138 -----------------------------------
6140 The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
6141 :ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
6142 pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
6143 have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
6146 .. code-block:: llvm
6151 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
6153 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
6154 ], section "llvm.metadata"
6156 If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
6157 and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
6158 symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
6159 a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
6160 ``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
6161 references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
6162 corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
6164 On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
6165 assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
6166 molesting the symbol.
6168 .. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
6170 The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
6171 --------------------------------------------
6173 The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
6174 directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
6175 symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
6176 optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
6179 This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
6180 and should not be exposed to source languages.
6182 .. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
6184 The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
6185 -------------------------------------------
6187 .. code-block:: llvm
6189 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
6190 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
6192 The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
6193 functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
6194 The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
6195 of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
6196 functions with the same priority is not defined.
6198 If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
6199 or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
6200 data from the current module is not discarded.
6202 .. _llvmglobaldtors:
6204 The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
6205 -------------------------------------------
6207 .. code-block:: llvm
6209 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
6210 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
6212 The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
6213 functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
6214 The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
6215 order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
6216 order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
6218 If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
6219 or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
6220 data from the current module is not discarded.
6222 Instruction Reference
6223 =====================
6225 The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
6226 of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
6227 instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
6228 instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
6229 :ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
6233 Terminator Instructions
6234 -----------------------
6236 As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
6237 program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
6238 block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
6239 terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
6240 control flow, not values (the one exception being the
6241 ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
6243 The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
6244 ':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
6245 ':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
6246 ':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`',
6247 ':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
6248 ':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`',
6249 and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
6253 '``ret``' Instruction
6254 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6261 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
6262 ret void ; Return from void function
6267 The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
6268 a value) from a function back to the caller.
6270 There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
6271 value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
6277 The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
6278 return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
6279 class <t_firstclass>`' type.
6281 A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it it has a non-void
6282 return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
6283 a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
6284 void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
6290 When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
6291 the calling function's context. If the caller is a
6292 ":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
6293 instruction after the call. If the caller was an
6294 ":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
6295 beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
6296 a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
6302 .. code-block:: llvm
6304 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5
6305 ret void ; Return from a void function
6306 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
6310 '``br``' Instruction
6311 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6318 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
6319 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch
6324 The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
6325 different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
6326 this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
6327 unconditional branch.
6332 The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
6333 '``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
6334 '``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
6339 Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
6340 argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
6341 '``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
6342 to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
6347 .. code-block:: llvm
6350 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
6351 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
6359 '``switch``' Instruction
6360 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6367 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
6372 The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
6373 several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
6374 instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
6380 The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
6381 comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
6382 array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
6383 is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
6388 The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
6389 When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
6390 for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
6391 to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
6392 to the default destination.
6397 Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
6398 ``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
6399 different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
6400 chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
6405 .. code-block:: llvm
6407 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
6408 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
6409 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
6411 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
6412 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
6414 ; Implement a jump table:
6415 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
6417 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
6421 '``indirectbr``' Instruction
6422 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6429 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
6434 The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
6435 label within the current function, whose address is specified by
6436 "``address``". Address must be derived from a
6437 :ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
6442 The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
6443 rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
6444 that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
6445 times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
6447 This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
6448 accurate understanding of the CFG.
6453 Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
6454 possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
6455 this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
6456 labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
6461 This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
6466 .. code-block:: llvm
6468 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
6472 '``invoke``' Instruction
6473 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6480 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)] [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
6481 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
6486 The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
6487 function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
6488 '``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
6489 returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
6490 "normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
6491 ":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
6492 mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
6493 nearest "exception" label.
6495 The '``exception``' label is a `landing
6496 pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
6497 '``exception``' label is required to have the
6498 ":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
6499 information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
6500 as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
6501 "``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
6502 instruction, so that the important information contained within the
6503 "``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
6508 This instruction requires several arguments:
6510 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
6511 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
6512 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
6513 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
6514 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
6516 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the adress space
6517 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
6518 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
6519 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
6520 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
6522 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being invoked. The
6523 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
6524 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
6525 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
6526 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
6527 indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
6529 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
6530 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
6531 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
6532 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
6533 extra arguments can be specified.
6534 #. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
6535 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
6536 #. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
6537 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
6539 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
6540 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
6545 This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
6546 instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
6547 establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
6548 library to unwind the stack.
6550 This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
6551 proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
6552 thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
6553 '``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
6555 For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
6556 by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
6557 current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
6558 return value is available.
6563 .. code-block:: llvm
6565 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
6566 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
6567 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
6568 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
6572 '``resume``' Instruction
6573 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6580 resume <type> <value>
6585 The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
6591 The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
6592 same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
6598 The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
6599 (in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
6600 :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
6605 .. code-block:: llvm
6607 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
6611 '``catchswitch``' Instruction
6612 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6619 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
6620 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
6625 The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system
6626 <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers
6627 that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`.
6632 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
6633 ``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet,
6634 this operand may be the token ``none``.
6636 The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with
6637 either a ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination
6638 must be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in
6639 the `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
6641 The ``handlers`` are a nonempty list of successor blocks that each begin with a
6642 :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.
6647 Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
6648 ``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
6651 The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that
6652 it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
6653 block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
6658 .. code-block:: text
6661 %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller
6663 %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup
6667 '``catchret``' Instruction
6668 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6675 catchret from <token> to label <normal>
6680 The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
6687 The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it
6688 exits. It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`.
6689 The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will
6695 The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
6696 unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. The
6697 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary
6698 code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to
6701 The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a ``catchpad`` instruction.
6702 If the specified ``catchpad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
6703 funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
6704 the ``catchret``'s behavior is undefined.
6709 .. code-block:: text
6711 catchret from %catch label %continue
6715 '``cleanupret``' Instruction
6716 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6723 cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue>
6724 cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller
6729 The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
6730 an optional successor.
6736 The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates
6737 which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`.
6738 If the specified ``cleanuppad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
6739 funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
6740 the ``cleanupret``'s behavior is undefined.
6742 The '``cleanupret``' instruction also has an optional successor, ``continue``,
6743 which must be the label of another basic block beginning with either a
6744 ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination must
6745 be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in the
6746 `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
6751 The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
6752 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one
6753 :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended.
6754 It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
6759 .. code-block:: text
6761 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller
6762 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue
6766 '``unreachable``' Instruction
6767 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6779 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
6780 instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
6781 the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
6782 after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
6787 The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
6794 Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
6795 They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
6796 them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
6797 data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
6798 result value has the same type as its operands.
6800 There are several different binary operators:
6804 '``add``' Instruction
6805 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6812 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6813 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6814 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6815 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6820 The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
6825 The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
6826 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6827 arguments must have identical types.
6832 The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
6834 If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
6835 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
6838 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
6839 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
6841 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
6842 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
6843 result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
6844 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
6849 .. code-block:: text
6851 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
6855 '``fadd``' Instruction
6856 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6863 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6868 The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
6873 The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be
6874 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
6875 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
6880 The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two operands.
6881 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
6882 environment <floatenv>`.
6883 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6884 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
6885 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
6890 .. code-block:: text
6892 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
6894 '``sub``' Instruction
6895 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6902 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6903 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6904 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6905 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6910 The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
6912 Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
6913 instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
6918 The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
6919 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6920 arguments must have identical types.
6925 The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
6927 If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
6928 mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
6931 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
6932 instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
6934 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
6935 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
6936 result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
6937 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
6942 .. code-block:: text
6944 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
6945 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var
6949 '``fsub``' Instruction
6950 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6957 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6962 The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
6964 Note that the '``fsub``' instruction is used to represent the '``fneg``'
6965 instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
6970 The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be
6971 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
6972 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
6977 The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two operands.
6978 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
6979 environment <floatenv>`.
6980 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6981 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
6982 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
6987 .. code-block:: text
6989 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
6990 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var
6992 '``mul``' Instruction
6993 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7000 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7001 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7002 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7003 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7008 The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
7013 The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
7014 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7015 arguments must have identical types.
7020 The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
7022 If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
7023 returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
7024 bit width of the result.
7026 Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
7027 result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
7028 correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
7029 (e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
7030 sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
7033 ``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
7034 respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
7035 result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
7036 unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
7041 .. code-block:: text
7043 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
7047 '``fmul``' Instruction
7048 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7055 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7060 The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
7065 The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be
7066 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7067 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7072 The value produced is the floating-point product of the two operands.
7073 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7074 environment <floatenv>`.
7075 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7076 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7077 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7082 .. code-block:: text
7084 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
7086 '``udiv``' Instruction
7087 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7094 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7095 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7100 The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7105 The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
7106 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7107 arguments must have identical types.
7112 The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
7114 Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
7115 distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
7117 Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
7118 of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
7121 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
7122 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
7123 such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
7128 .. code-block:: text
7130 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
7132 '``sdiv``' Instruction
7133 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7140 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7141 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7146 The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7151 The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
7152 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7153 arguments must have identical types.
7158 The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
7159 rounded towards zero.
7161 Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
7162 distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
7164 Division by zero is undefined behavior. For vectors, if any element
7165 of the divisor is zero, the operation has undefined behavior.
7166 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
7167 occur, for example, by doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
7169 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
7170 a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
7175 .. code-block:: text
7177 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
7181 '``fdiv``' Instruction
7182 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7189 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7194 The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
7199 The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be
7200 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7201 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7206 The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two operands.
7207 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7208 environment <floatenv>`.
7209 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7210 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7211 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7216 .. code-block:: text
7218 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
7220 '``urem``' Instruction
7221 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7228 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7233 The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
7234 division of its two arguments.
7239 The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
7240 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7241 arguments must have identical types.
7246 This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
7247 This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
7250 Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
7251 distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
7253 Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
7254 For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
7260 .. code-block:: text
7262 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
7264 '``srem``' Instruction
7265 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7272 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7277 The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
7278 division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
7279 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
7285 The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
7286 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7287 arguments must have identical types.
7292 This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
7293 is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
7294 *modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
7295 as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
7296 difference, see `The Math
7297 Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
7298 table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
7300 operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
7302 Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
7303 distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
7305 Taking the remainder of a division by zero is undefined behavior.
7306 For vectors, if any element of the divisor is zero, the operation has
7308 Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
7309 occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
7310 -2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
7311 rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
7312 result of the division and the remainder.)
7317 .. code-block:: text
7319 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
7323 '``frem``' Instruction
7324 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7331 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7336 The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
7342 The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be
7343 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of
7344 floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
7349 The value produced is the floating-point remainder of the two operands.
7350 This is the same output as a libm '``fmod``' function, but without any
7351 possibility of setting ``errno``. The remainder has the same sign as the
7353 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
7354 environment <floatenv>`.
7355 This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
7356 flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
7357 unsafe floating-point optimizations:
7362 .. code-block:: text
7364 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
7368 Bitwise Binary Operations
7369 -------------------------
7371 Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
7372 in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
7373 commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
7374 operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
7375 single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
7377 '``shl``' Instruction
7378 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7385 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7386 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7387 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7388 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7393 The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
7394 a specified number of bits.
7399 Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
7400 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7401 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7406 The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
7407 where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
7408 dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
7409 ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
7410 If the arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted
7411 by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7413 If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
7414 value if it shifts out any non-zero bits.
7415 If the ``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
7416 value if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the resultant sign bit.
7421 .. code-block:: text
7423 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var
7424 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16
7425 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024
7426 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7427 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
7429 '``lshr``' Instruction
7430 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7437 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7438 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7443 The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
7444 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
7449 Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
7450 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7451 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7456 This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
7457 most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
7458 the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
7459 than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
7460 value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
7461 of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7463 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
7464 a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
7469 .. code-block:: text
7471 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
7472 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
7473 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
7474 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
7475 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7476 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
7478 '``ashr``' Instruction
7479 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7486 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7487 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7492 The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
7493 operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
7499 Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
7500 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
7501 '``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
7506 This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
7507 The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
7508 of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
7509 than the number of bits in ``op1``, this instruction returns a :ref:`poison
7510 value <poisonvalues>`. If the arguments are vectors, each vector element
7511 of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
7513 If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
7514 a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are non-zero.
7519 .. code-block:: text
7521 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
7522 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
7523 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
7524 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
7525 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
7526 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
7528 '``and``' Instruction
7529 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7536 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7541 The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
7547 The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
7548 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7549 arguments must have identical types.
7554 The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
7571 .. code-block:: text
7573 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
7574 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8
7575 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0
7577 '``or``' Instruction
7578 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7585 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7590 The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
7596 The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
7597 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7598 arguments must have identical types.
7603 The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
7622 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
7623 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47
7624 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
7626 '``xor``' Instruction
7627 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7634 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
7639 The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
7640 its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
7641 complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
7646 The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
7647 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
7648 arguments must have identical types.
7653 The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
7670 .. code-block:: text
7672 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
7673 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39
7674 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
7675 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V
7680 LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
7681 target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
7682 and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
7683 While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
7684 sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
7685 take full advantage of a specific target.
7687 .. _i_extractelement:
7689 '``extractelement``' Instruction
7690 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7697 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
7702 The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
7703 from a vector at a specified index.
7708 The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
7709 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
7710 the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
7711 variable of any integer type.
7716 The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
7717 Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
7718 exceeds the length of ``val``, the result is a
7719 :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
7724 .. code-block:: text
7726 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32
7728 .. _i_insertelement:
7730 '``insertelement``' Instruction
7731 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7738 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>>
7743 The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
7744 vector at a specified index.
7749 The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
7750 :ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
7751 type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
7752 is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
7753 index may be a variable of any integer type.
7758 The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
7759 are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
7760 ``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val``, the result
7761 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
7766 .. code-block:: text
7768 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32>
7770 .. _i_shufflevector:
7772 '``shufflevector``' Instruction
7773 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7780 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
7785 The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
7786 from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
7787 the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
7792 The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
7793 with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
7794 type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
7795 length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
7796 same as the element type of the first two operands.
7798 The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
7799 constant integer or undef values.
7804 The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
7805 across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
7806 element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
7807 result element gets. If the shuffle mask is undef, the result vector is
7808 undef. If any element of the mask operand is undef, that element of the
7809 result is undef. If the shuffle mask selects an undef element from one
7810 of the input vectors, the resulting element is undef.
7815 .. code-block:: text
7817 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
7818 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
7819 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
7820 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
7821 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
7822 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
7823 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
7824 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
7826 Aggregate Operations
7827 --------------------
7829 LLVM supports several instructions for working with
7830 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
7834 '``extractvalue``' Instruction
7835 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7842 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
7847 The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
7848 from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
7853 The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
7854 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are
7855 constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
7856 as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
7858 The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
7860 - Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
7861 omitted and assumed to be zero.
7862 - At least one index must be specified.
7863 - Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
7868 The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
7874 .. code-block:: text
7876 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32
7880 '``insertvalue``' Instruction
7881 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7888 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
7893 The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
7894 an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
7899 The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
7900 :ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
7901 a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
7902 indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
7903 similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
7904 to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
7910 The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
7911 that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
7912 indices is that of ``elt``.
7917 .. code-block:: llvm
7919 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
7920 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
7921 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
7925 Memory Access and Addressing Operations
7926 ---------------------------------------
7928 A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
7929 memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
7930 very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
7935 '``alloca``' Instruction
7936 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7943 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] [, addrspace(<num>)] ; yields type addrspace(num)*:result
7948 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
7949 currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
7950 function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
7951 address space for allocas indicated in the datalayout.
7956 The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
7957 bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
7958 appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
7959 the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
7960 to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
7961 allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
7962 alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
7963 zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
7964 boundary compatible with the type.
7966 '``type``' may be any sized type.
7971 Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined
7972 if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '``alloca``'d
7973 memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
7974 '``alloca``' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
7975 variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
7976 (either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions), the memory is
7977 reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the returned pointer may not
7978 be unique. The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack
7979 grows) is not specified.
7984 .. code-block:: llvm
7986 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
7987 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr
7988 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
7989 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
7993 '``load``' Instruction
7994 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8001 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
8002 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
8003 !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
8004 !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
8005 !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
8010 The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
8015 The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address from which
8016 to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
8017 known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>`). If
8018 the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to
8019 modify the number or order of execution of this ``load`` with other
8020 :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8022 If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
8023 <ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
8024 ``release`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load`` instructions.
8025 Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
8026 multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
8027 floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
8028 eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
8029 explicitly specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the
8030 alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
8031 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads.
8033 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
8034 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
8035 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
8036 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
8037 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
8038 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
8039 may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
8040 maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment value higher
8041 than the size of the loaded type implies memory up to the alignment
8042 value bytes can be safely loaded without trapping in the default
8043 address space. Access of the high bytes can interfere with debugging
8044 tools, so should not be accessed if the function has the
8045 ``sanitize_thread`` or ``sanitize_address`` attributes.
8047 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
8048 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
8049 ``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
8050 metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
8051 that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
8052 generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
8053 as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
8055 The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
8056 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
8057 entries. If a load instruction tagged with the ``!invariant.load``
8058 metadata is executed, the optimizer may assume the memory location
8059 referenced by the load contains the same value at all points in the
8060 program where the memory location is known to be dereferenceable;
8061 otherwise, the behavior is undefined.
8063 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
8064 ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no entries.
8065 See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
8067 The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
8068 metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
8069 entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
8070 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
8071 never be null. If the value is null at runtime, the behavior is undefined.
8072 This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute on parameters and return
8073 values. This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
8075 The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
8076 name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
8077 entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
8078 tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
8079 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
8080 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
8081 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
8082 to loads of a pointer type.
8084 The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
8085 metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
8086 ``i64`` entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
8087 instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
8088 dereferenceable or null.
8089 The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
8090 value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
8091 attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
8092 to loads of a pointer type.
8094 The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
8095 ``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry.
8096 The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the
8097 optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
8098 by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
8099 This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values.
8100 This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type. If the returned
8101 value is not appropriately aligned at runtime, the behavior is undefined.
8106 The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
8107 is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
8108 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
8109 example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
8110 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
8111 of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
8112 written using a store of the same type.
8117 .. code-block:: llvm
8119 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8120 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
8121 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
8125 '``store``' Instruction
8126 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8133 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
8134 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
8139 The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
8144 There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store and an
8145 address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>`` operand must be a
8146 pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of the ``<value>``
8147 operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
8148 allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this ``store`` with other
8149 :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`. Only values of :ref:`first class
8150 <t_firstclass>` types of known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque
8151 structural type <t_opaque>`) can be stored.
8153 If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
8154 <ordering>` and optional ``syncscope("<target-scope>")`` argument. The
8155 ``acquire`` and ``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store`` instructions.
8156 Atomic loads produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see
8157 multiple atomic stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or
8158 floating-point type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to
8159 eight and less than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be
8160 explicitly specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if
8161 the alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
8162 pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
8164 The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
8165 operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
8166 or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
8167 alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
8168 to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
8169 alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
8170 alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
8171 safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment
8172 value higher than the size of the stored type implies memory up to the
8173 alignment value bytes can be stored to without trapping in the default
8174 address space. Storing to the higher bytes however may result in data
8175 races if another thread can access the same address. Introducing a
8176 data race is not allowed. Storing to the extra bytes is not allowed
8177 even in situations where a data race is known to not exist if the
8178 function has the ``sanitize_address`` attribute.
8180 The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
8181 name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
8182 value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
8183 tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
8184 be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
8185 instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on
8188 The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a
8189 single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
8194 The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
8195 location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
8196 of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
8197 minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
8198 example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
8199 value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
8200 of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
8201 belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
8206 .. code-block:: llvm
8208 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
8209 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
8210 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
8214 '``fence``' Instruction
8215 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8222 fence [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields void
8227 The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
8233 '``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
8234 defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
8235 ``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
8240 A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
8241 *synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
8242 semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
8243 operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
8244 modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
8245 headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
8246 *happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
8247 ``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
8248 provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
8249 still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
8250 *happens-before* edge.
8252 A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
8253 ``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
8254 the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
8256 A ``fence`` instruction can also take an optional
8257 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8262 .. code-block:: text
8264 fence acquire ; yields void
8265 fence syncscope("singlethread") seq_cst ; yields void
8266 fence syncscope("agent") seq_cst ; yields void
8270 '``cmpxchg``' Instruction
8271 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8278 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
8283 The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
8284 loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
8285 equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
8290 There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
8291 to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
8292 address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
8293 are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer or pointer type whose
8294 bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
8295 than or equal to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must
8296 have the same type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to
8297 that type. If the ``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the
8298 optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of execution of
8299 this ``cmpxchg`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
8301 The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
8302 ``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
8303 must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
8304 stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
8305 ``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
8307 A ``cmpxchg`` instruction can also take an optional
8308 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8310 The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
8311 equal to the size in memory of the operand.
8316 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
8317 is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the values are equal, '``<new>``' is
8318 written to the location. The original value at the location is returned,
8319 together with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
8321 If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
8322 permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
8325 If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
8326 if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
8328 A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
8329 identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
8330 load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
8335 .. code-block:: llvm
8338 %orig = load atomic i32, i32* %ptr unordered, align 4 ; yields i32
8342 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%value_loaded, %loop]
8343 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
8344 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
8345 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
8346 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
8347 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
8354 '``atomicrmw``' Instruction
8355 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8362 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [syncscope("<target-scope>")] <ordering> ; yields ty
8367 The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
8372 There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
8373 operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
8374 operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
8388 The type of '<value>' must be an integer type whose bit width is a power
8389 of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal to a
8390 target-specific size limit. The type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must
8391 be a pointer to that type. If the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as
8392 ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or
8393 order of execution of this ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile
8394 operations <volatile>`.
8396 A ``atomicrmw`` instruction can also take an optional
8397 ":ref:`syncscope <syncscope>`" argument.
8402 The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
8403 operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
8404 value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
8407 - xchg: ``*ptr = val``
8408 - add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
8409 - sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
8410 - and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
8411 - nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
8412 - or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
8413 - xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
8414 - max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
8415 - min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
8416 - umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
8418 - umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
8424 .. code-block:: llvm
8426 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32
8428 .. _i_getelementptr:
8430 '``getelementptr``' Instruction
8431 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8438 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
8439 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, [inrange] <ty> <idx>}*
8440 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, [inrange] <vector index type> <idx>
8445 The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
8446 subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
8447 address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
8448 be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
8453 The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
8454 The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
8455 base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
8456 that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
8457 The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
8458 into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
8459 second argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
8460 (not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
8461 can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
8462 value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
8463 subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
8464 would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
8466 The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
8467 When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
8468 **constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
8469 be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
8470 pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
8471 required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
8474 For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
8490 int *foo(struct ST *s) {
8491 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
8494 The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
8496 .. code-block:: llvm
8498 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
8499 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
8501 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
8503 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
8510 In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
8511 '``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
8512 = '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
8513 indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
8514 '``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
8515 structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
8516 structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
8517 dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
8518 type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
8519 element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
8521 Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
8522 returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
8523 for the given testcase is equivalent to:
8525 .. code-block:: llvm
8527 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
8528 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
8529 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
8530 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
8531 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
8532 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
8536 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
8537 ``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
8538 pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
8539 of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
8540 offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
8541 precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
8542 allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
8543 all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
8544 past the end. The only *in bounds* address for a null pointer in the
8545 default address-space is the null pointer itself. In cases where the
8546 base is a vector of pointers the ``inbounds`` keyword applies to each
8547 of the computations element-wise.
8549 If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
8550 base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
8551 offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
8552 or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
8553 ``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
8554 pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
8555 though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
8556 :ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
8559 If the ``inrange`` keyword is present before any index, loading from or
8560 storing to any pointer derived from the ``getelementptr`` has undefined
8561 behavior if the load or store would access memory outside of the bounds of
8562 the element selected by the index marked as ``inrange``. The result of a
8563 pointer comparison or ``ptrtoint`` (including ``ptrtoint``-like operations
8564 involving memory) involving a pointer derived from a ``getelementptr`` with
8565 the ``inrange`` keyword is undefined, with the exception of comparisons
8566 in the case where both operands are in the range of the element selected
8567 by the ``inrange`` keyword, inclusive of the address one past the end of
8568 that element. Note that the ``inrange`` keyword is currently only allowed
8569 in constant ``getelementptr`` expressions.
8571 The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
8572 into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
8577 .. code-block:: llvm
8579 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
8580 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
8582 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
8584 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
8586 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
8591 The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
8592 when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
8593 arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
8594 will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
8596 .. code-block:: llvm
8598 ; All arguments are vectors:
8599 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
8600 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
8602 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
8603 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
8604 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
8606 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
8607 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
8608 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
8610 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
8612 The two following instructions are equivalent:
8614 .. code-block:: llvm
8616 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
8617 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
8618 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
8620 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
8622 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
8623 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
8625 Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
8630 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
8631 double *A, *B; int *C;
8632 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
8636 .. code-block:: llvm
8638 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
8639 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
8640 ; load 8 elements from array B into A
8641 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64.v8p0f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
8642 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
8644 Conversion Operations
8645 ---------------------
8647 The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
8648 (casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
8649 various bit conversions on the operand.
8653 '``trunc .. to``' Instruction
8654 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8661 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8666 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
8671 The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
8672 it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
8673 of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
8674 larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
8675 types are not allowed.
8680 The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
8681 and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
8682 be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
8683 It will always truncate bits.
8688 .. code-block:: llvm
8690 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1
8691 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true
8692 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false
8693 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
8697 '``zext .. to``' Instruction
8698 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8705 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8710 The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
8715 The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
8716 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
8717 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
8718 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
8723 The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
8724 until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
8726 When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
8731 .. code-block:: llvm
8733 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257
8734 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1
8735 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
8739 '``sext .. to``' Instruction
8740 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8747 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8752 The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
8757 The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
8758 to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
8759 the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
8760 smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
8765 The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
8766 bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
8767 of the type ``ty2``.
8769 When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
8774 .. code-block:: llvm
8776 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535
8777 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1
8778 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
8780 '``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
8781 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8788 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8793 The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
8798 The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
8799 value to cast and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
8800 The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
8801 implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
8806 The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger
8807 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating-point
8809 This instruction is assumed to execute in the default :ref:`floating-point
8810 environment <floatenv>`.
8815 .. code-block:: llvm
8817 %X = fptrunc double 16777217.0 to float ; yields float:16777216.0
8818 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to half ; yields half:+infinity
8820 '``fpext .. to``' Instruction
8821 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8828 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8833 The '``fpext``' extends a floating-point ``value`` to a larger floating-point
8839 The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
8840 ``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to cast it
8841 to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
8846 The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
8847 :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating-point
8848 <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
8849 *no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
8850 *no-op cast* for a floating-point cast.
8855 .. code-block:: llvm
8857 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00
8858 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
8860 '``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
8861 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8868 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8873 The '``fptoui``' converts a floating-point ``value`` to its unsigned
8874 integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
8879 The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
8880 scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
8881 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
8882 ``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
8883 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
8888 The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
8889 <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
8890 unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the result
8891 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
8896 .. code-block:: llvm
8898 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123
8899 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
8900 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
8902 '``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
8903 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8910 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8915 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>`
8916 ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
8921 The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
8922 scalar or vector :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
8923 cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
8924 ``ty`` is a vector floating-point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
8925 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
8930 The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating-point
8931 <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
8932 signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the result
8933 is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>`.
8938 .. code-block:: llvm
8940 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123
8941 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
8942 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
8944 '``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
8945 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8952 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8957 The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
8958 and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
8963 The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
8964 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
8965 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
8966 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
8967 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
8972 The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
8973 integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point
8974 value. If the value cannot be exactly represented, it is rounded using
8975 the default rounding mode.
8981 .. code-block:: llvm
8983 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
8984 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0
8986 '``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
8987 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8994 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8999 The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
9000 converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
9005 The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9006 scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
9007 ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` type. If
9008 ``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating-point
9009 type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
9014 The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
9015 quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating-point value. If the
9016 value cannot be exactly represented, it is rounded using the default rounding
9022 .. code-block:: llvm
9024 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
9025 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0
9029 '``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
9030 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9037 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9042 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
9043 pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
9048 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
9049 a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
9050 type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
9051 a vector of integers type.
9056 The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
9057 ``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
9058 truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
9059 If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
9060 ``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
9061 the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
9067 .. code-block:: llvm
9069 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
9070 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
9071 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
9075 '``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
9076 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9083 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9088 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
9089 pointer type, ``ty2``.
9094 The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
9095 cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
9101 The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
9102 applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
9103 of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
9104 pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
9105 of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
9106 nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
9111 .. code-block:: llvm
9113 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
9114 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
9115 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
9116 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
9120 '``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
9121 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9128 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
9133 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
9139 The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
9140 non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
9141 also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
9142 bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
9143 identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
9144 also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
9145 conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
9146 long as they have the same size).
9151 The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
9152 is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
9153 conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
9154 to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
9155 pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
9156 pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
9157 To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
9158 or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
9163 .. code-block:: text
9165 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1
9166 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x
9167 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V
9168 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
9170 .. _i_addrspacecast:
9172 '``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
9173 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9180 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2
9185 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
9186 address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
9191 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
9192 to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
9198 The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
9199 ``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
9200 value modification, depending on the target and the address space
9201 pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
9202 performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
9203 conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
9209 .. code-block:: llvm
9211 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
9212 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
9213 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
9220 The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
9221 which defy better classification.
9225 '``icmp``' Instruction
9226 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9233 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
9238 The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
9239 boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
9240 pointer, or pointer vector operands.
9245 The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
9246 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
9247 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
9250 #. ``ne``: not equal
9251 #. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
9252 #. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
9253 #. ``ult``: unsigned less than
9254 #. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
9255 #. ``sgt``: signed greater than
9256 #. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
9257 #. ``slt``: signed less than
9258 #. ``sle``: signed less or equal
9260 The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
9261 :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
9262 must also be identical types.
9267 The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
9268 code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
9269 :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
9271 #. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
9272 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
9273 #. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
9274 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
9275 #. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9276 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
9277 #. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9278 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9279 #. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9280 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
9281 #. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
9282 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9283 #. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9284 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
9285 #. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9286 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9287 #. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9288 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
9289 #. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
9290 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9292 If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
9293 are compared as if they were integers.
9295 If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
9296 element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
9297 as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
9302 .. code-block:: text
9304 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9305 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
9306 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
9307 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9308 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9309 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
9313 '``fcmp``' Instruction
9314 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9321 <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
9326 The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
9327 values based on comparison of its operands.
9329 If the operands are floating-point scalars, then the result type is a
9330 boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
9332 If the operands are floating-point vectors, then the result type is a
9333 vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
9339 The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
9340 the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
9341 not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
9343 #. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
9344 #. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
9345 #. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
9346 #. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
9347 #. ``olt``: ordered and less than
9348 #. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
9349 #. ``one``: ordered and not equal
9350 #. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
9351 #. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
9352 #. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
9353 #. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
9354 #. ``ult``: unordered or less than
9355 #. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
9356 #. ``une``: unordered or not equal
9357 #. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
9358 #. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
9360 *Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
9361 that either operand may be a QNAN.
9363 Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating-point
9364 <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating-point type.
9365 They must have identical types.
9370 The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
9371 condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
9372 vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
9373 always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
9375 #. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
9376 #. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9377 is equal to ``op2``.
9378 #. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9379 is greater than ``op2``.
9380 #. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9381 is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9382 #. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9383 is less than ``op2``.
9384 #. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9385 is less than or equal to ``op2``.
9386 #. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
9387 is not equal to ``op2``.
9388 #. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
9389 #. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9391 #. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9392 greater than ``op2``.
9393 #. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9394 greater than or equal to ``op2``.
9395 #. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9397 #. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9398 less than or equal to ``op2``.
9399 #. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
9400 not equal to ``op2``.
9401 #. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
9402 #. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
9404 The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of
9405 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
9406 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations.
9408 Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the
9409 only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
9410 assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
9411 ``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``reassoc``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information.
9416 .. code-block:: text
9418 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
9419 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
9420 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
9421 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
9425 '``phi``' Instruction
9426 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9433 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
9438 The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
9439 graph representing the function.
9444 The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
9445 After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
9446 arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
9447 block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
9448 the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
9451 There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
9452 and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
9455 For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
9456 deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
9457 the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
9458 instruction's return value on the same edge).
9463 At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
9464 specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
9465 executed just prior to the current block.
9470 .. code-block:: llvm
9472 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
9473 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
9474 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
9479 '``select``' Instruction
9480 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9487 <result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
9489 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
9494 The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
9495 condition, without IR-level branching.
9500 The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
9501 values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
9502 class <t_firstclass>` type.
9507 If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
9508 the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
9511 If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
9512 vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
9514 If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
9515 same size, then an entire vector is selected.
9520 .. code-block:: llvm
9522 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17
9526 '``call``' Instruction
9527 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9534 <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] [addrspace(<num>)]
9535 [<ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs] [ operand bundles ]
9540 The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
9545 This instruction requires several arguments:
9547 #. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
9548 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
9549 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
9550 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
9551 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
9553 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
9554 recursive cycle in the call graph.
9555 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
9558 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas from the caller.
9559 The ``tail`` marker additionally implies that the callee does not access
9560 varargs from the caller, while ``musttail`` implies that varargs from the
9561 caller are passed to the callee. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the
9562 following additional rules:
9564 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
9565 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
9566 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
9567 produced by the call or void.
9568 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
9569 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
9571 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
9572 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
9573 returned, and inalloca, must match.
9574 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
9575 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
9576 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
9578 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
9579 the following conditions are met:
9581 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
9582 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
9583 uses value of call or is void).
9584 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
9585 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
9586 - `Platform-specific constraints are
9587 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
9589 #. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add
9590 ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail
9591 call optimization from being performed on the call.
9593 #. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the call has one or more
9594 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
9595 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
9596 for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
9598 #. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
9599 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
9600 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
9601 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
9602 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
9603 #. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
9604 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
9606 #. The optional addrspace attribute can be used to indicate the adress space
9607 of the called function. If it is not specified, the program address space
9608 from the :ref:`datalayout string<langref_datalayout>` will be used.
9609 #. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
9610 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
9612 #. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being called. The
9613 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
9614 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
9615 #. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
9616 be called. In most cases, this is a direct function call, but
9617 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
9619 #. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
9620 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
9621 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
9622 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
9623 extra arguments can be specified.
9624 #. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list.
9625 #. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
9630 The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
9631 a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
9632 values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
9633 flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
9634 return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
9639 .. code-block:: llvm
9641 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
9642 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
9643 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
9644 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
9645 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
9647 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
9648 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
9649 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
9650 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
9651 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
9652 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
9654 llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
9655 the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
9656 perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
9657 This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
9658 support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
9662 '``va_arg``' Instruction
9663 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9670 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
9675 The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
9676 the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
9677 the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
9682 This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
9683 argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
9684 increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
9685 type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
9690 The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
9691 from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
9692 the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
9693 handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
9695 It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
9696 not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
9699 ``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
9700 function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
9705 See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
9707 Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
9708 targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
9709 types on any target.
9713 '``landingpad``' Instruction
9714 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9721 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
9722 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
9724 <clause> := catch <type> <value>
9725 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
9730 The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
9731 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
9732 is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
9733 code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
9734 defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
9735 re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
9741 ``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
9743 A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
9744 contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
9745 or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
9746 clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
9747 "``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
9748 '``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
9749 the ``cleanup`` flag.
9754 The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
9755 :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
9756 therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
9757 calling conventions, how the personality function results are
9758 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
9760 The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
9761 ``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
9762 clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
9763 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
9764 the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
9765 match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
9766 unwinding continues further up the call stack.
9768 The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
9770 - A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
9771 of an '``invoke``' instruction.
9772 - A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
9773 first non-PHI instruction.
9774 - There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
9776 - A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
9777 '``landingpad``' instruction.
9782 .. code-block:: llvm
9784 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
9785 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
9787 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
9788 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
9790 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
9791 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
9793 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
9797 '``catchpad``' Instruction
9798 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9805 <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*]
9810 The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
9811 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
9812 begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
9813 control to catch an exception.
9818 The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a
9819 :ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This
9820 ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
9821 terminates in a ``catchswitch``.
9823 The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine
9824 requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
9825 will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for
9828 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the
9829 ``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH
9835 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
9836 exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will
9837 not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction. The representation of ``args`` is
9838 entirely target and personality function-specific.
9840 Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad``
9841 instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
9843 The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad"
9844 instructions is described in the
9845 `Windows exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`_.
9847 When a ``catchpad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
9848 described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
9849 it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
9850 that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
9855 .. code-block:: text
9858 %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller
9859 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
9861 %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi]
9865 '``cleanuppad``' Instruction
9866 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9873 <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*]
9878 The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
9879 system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
9880 is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
9881 transfer control to run cleanup actions.
9882 The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
9883 information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
9884 execute the cleanup.
9885 The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to
9886 match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`.
9887 The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
9888 ``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet,
9889 this operand may be the token ``none``.
9894 The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
9895 by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
9900 When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
9901 the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
9902 ``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
9903 As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
9904 represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
9906 The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions:
9908 - A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
9909 an exceptional instruction.
9910 - A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its
9911 first non-PHI instruction.
9912 - There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the
9914 - A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
9915 '``cleanuppad``' instruction.
9917 When a ``cleanuppad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
9918 described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
9919 it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
9920 that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
9925 .. code-block:: text
9927 %tok = cleanuppad within %cs []
9934 LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
9935 have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
9936 restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
9937 for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
9938 transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
9939 reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
9941 Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
9942 prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
9943 not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
9944 functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
9945 functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
9946 to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
9947 intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
9948 are added that they be documented here.
9950 Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
9951 represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
9952 different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
9953 different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
9954 intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
9955 argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
9956 integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
9957 previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
9958 function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
9959 of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
9960 argument or the result.
9962 Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
9963 types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
9964 those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
9965 whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
9966 ``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
9967 integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
9968 functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
9969 ``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
9970 overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
9971 type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
9974 To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
9975 LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
9979 Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
9980 -------------------------------------
9982 Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
9983 :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
9984 functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
9985 defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
9987 All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
9988 value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
9989 does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
9990 prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
9992 This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
9993 variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
9995 .. code-block:: llvm
9997 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
9998 ; it is merely an i8*.
9999 %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
10001 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
10002 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
10004 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
10005 ; Initialize variable argument processing
10006 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
10007 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
10008 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
10010 ; Read a single integer argument
10011 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
10013 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
10015 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
10016 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
10017 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
10019 ; Stop processing of arguments.
10020 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
10024 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
10025 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
10026 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
10030 '``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
10031 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10038 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
10043 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
10044 subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
10049 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
10054 The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
10055 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
10056 ``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
10057 to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
10058 function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
10059 to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
10062 '``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
10063 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10070 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
10075 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
10076 initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
10081 The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
10086 The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
10087 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
10088 element to which the argument points. Calls to
10089 :ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
10090 :ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
10095 '``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
10096 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10103 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
10108 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
10109 from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
10114 The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
10115 The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
10120 The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
10121 available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
10122 ``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
10123 intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
10124 arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
10126 Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
10127 --------------------------------------
10129 LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
10130 (GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
10131 calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
10132 intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
10134 These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
10135 stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
10136 require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
10137 Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
10138 these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
10139 details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
10141 Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
10142 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10144 LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
10145 collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
10146 to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
10147 :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
10148 differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
10149 <GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
10150 described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
10154 '``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
10155 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10162 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
10167 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
10168 the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
10173 The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
10174 the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
10175 a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
10181 At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
10182 "ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
10183 information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
10184 The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
10185 :ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
10189 '``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
10190 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10197 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
10202 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
10203 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
10209 The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
10210 address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
10211 pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
10212 runtime (otherwise null).
10217 The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
10218 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
10219 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
10220 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
10225 '``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
10226 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10233 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
10238 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
10239 locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
10240 barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
10245 The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
10246 the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
10247 Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
10248 object, Obj may be null.
10253 The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
10254 instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
10255 the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
10256 intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
10259 Code Generator Intrinsics
10260 -------------------------
10262 These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
10263 may only be implemented with code generator support.
10265 '``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
10266 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10273 declare i8* @llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
10278 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
10279 target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
10280 function or one of its callers.
10285 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
10286 address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
10287 caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
10293 The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
10294 indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
10295 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
10296 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
10297 used for debugging purposes.
10299 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10300 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10301 of the obvious source-language caller.
10303 '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' Intrinsic
10304 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10311 declare i8* @llvm.addressofreturnaddress()
10316 The '``llvm.addressofreturnaddress``' intrinsic returns a target-specific
10317 pointer to the place in the stack frame where the return address of the
10318 current function is stored.
10323 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10324 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10325 of the obvious source-language caller.
10327 This intrinsic is only implemented for x86.
10329 '``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
10330 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10337 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
10342 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
10343 target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
10348 The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
10349 frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
10350 its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
10356 The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
10357 indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
10358 cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
10359 be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
10360 used for debugging purposes.
10362 Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
10363 other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
10364 of the obvious source-language caller.
10366 '``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
10367 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10374 declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
10375 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
10380 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
10381 allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
10382 live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
10383 computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
10388 All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
10389 casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
10390 once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
10392 The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
10393 bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
10394 generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
10397 The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
10398 call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
10399 is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
10400 pointer in platform-specific ways.
10402 The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
10403 '``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
10408 These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
10409 stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
10410 '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
10411 child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
10412 The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
10413 the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
10414 '``llvm.localrecover``'.
10416 .. _int_read_register:
10417 .. _int_write_register:
10419 '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
10420 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10427 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
10428 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
10429 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
10430 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
10436 The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
10437 provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
10438 the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
10439 with the register being read.
10444 The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
10445 register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
10446 the current value of the register, where possible.
10448 This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
10449 to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
10450 bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
10452 The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
10453 register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
10454 allocatable registers are not supported.
10456 Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
10457 architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
10458 work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
10463 '``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
10464 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10471 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
10476 The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
10477 of the function stack, for use with
10478 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
10479 implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
10485 This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
10486 :ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
10487 ``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
10488 ``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
10489 the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
10490 practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
10491 were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
10493 .. _int_stackrestore:
10495 '``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
10496 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10503 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
10508 The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
10509 the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
10510 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
10511 useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
10512 sized arrays in C99.
10517 See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
10519 .. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset:
10521 '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic
10522 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10529 declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
10530 declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
10535 The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
10536 get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
10537 recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
10538 intendend for use in combination with
10539 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
10540 pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
10541 for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
10546 These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to
10547 get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>`
10548 on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards,
10549 adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most
10550 recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more
10551 complicated, because subtracting this value from stack pointer would get the address
10552 one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
10554 Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
10555 returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a
10556 compile-time-known constant value.
10558 The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
10559 must match the target's default address space's (address space 0) pointer type.
10561 '``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
10562 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10569 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
10574 The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
10575 insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
10576 Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
10577 its performance characteristics.
10582 ``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
10583 determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
10584 ``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
10585 locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
10586 specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
10587 instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
10588 arguments must be constant integers.
10593 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
10594 particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
10595 targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
10596 the processor cache for better performance.
10598 '``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
10599 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10606 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
10611 The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
10612 Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
10613 method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
10614 exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
10615 guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
10616 optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
10617 optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
10618 allow correlations of simulation runs.
10623 ``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
10628 This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
10629 that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
10631 '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
10632 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10639 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
10644 The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
10645 counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
10646 targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
10647 should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
10648 order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
10654 When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
10655 memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
10656 specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
10657 is lowered to a constant 0.
10659 Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
10660 running at and the host platform.
10662 '``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
10663 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10670 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
10675 The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
10676 in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
10677 targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
10678 flushes the instruction cache.
10683 On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
10684 intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
10685 cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
10686 instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
10689 The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
10692 This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
10693 of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
10695 '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' Intrinsic
10696 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10703 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
10704 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
10709 The '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
10710 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
10711 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
10712 program at runtime.
10717 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
10718 name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
10719 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
10721 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
10722 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
10723 the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
10724 error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
10725 ``instrprof.increment`` that refer to the same name.
10727 The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
10728 be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
10733 This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
10734 cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
10735 structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
10736 format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
10737 the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
10739 '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' Intrinsic
10740 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10747 declare void @llvm.instrprof.increment.step(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
10748 i32 <num-counters>,
10749 i32 <index>, i64 <step>)
10754 The '``llvm.instrprof.increment.step``' intrinsic is an extension to
10755 the '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' intrinsic with an additional fifth
10756 argument to specify the step of the increment.
10760 The first four arguments are the same as '``llvm.instrprof.increment``'
10763 The last argument specifies the value of the increment of the counter variable.
10767 See description of '``llvm.instrprof.increment``' instrinsic.
10770 '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' Intrinsic
10771 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10778 declare void @llvm.instrprof.value.profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
10779 i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
10785 The '``llvm.instrprof.value.profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
10786 frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
10787 lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values,
10788 instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
10793 The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
10794 name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the
10795 (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
10797 The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
10798 of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
10799 is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of
10800 ``llvm.instrprof.*`` that refer to the same name.
10802 The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
10803 expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
10804 fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
10805 supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
10806 ``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the
10807 ``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the
10808 index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0.
10813 This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
10814 should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof``
10815 pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
10816 ``llvm.instrprof.value.profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile
10817 runtime library with proper arguments.
10819 '``llvm.thread.pointer``' Intrinsic
10820 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10827 declare i8* @llvm.thread.pointer()
10832 The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns the value of the thread
10838 The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns a pointer to the TLS area
10839 for the current thread. The exact semantics of this value are target
10840 specific: it may point to the start of TLS area, to the end, or somewhere
10841 in the middle. Depending on the target, this intrinsic may read a register,
10842 call a helper function, read from an alternate memory space, or perform
10843 other operations necessary to locate the TLS area. Not all targets support
10846 Standard C Library Intrinsics
10847 -----------------------------
10849 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
10850 functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
10851 information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
10852 generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
10856 '``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
10857 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10862 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
10863 integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
10864 support all bit widths however.
10868 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
10869 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
10870 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
10871 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
10876 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
10877 source location to the destination location.
10879 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
10880 intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra isvolatile
10881 arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
10886 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
10887 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
10888 specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
10889 boolean indicating a volatile access.
10891 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
10892 for the first and second arguments.
10894 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
10895 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
10896 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
10901 The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
10902 source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
10903 overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
10904 to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth
10905 argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
10909 '``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
10910 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10915 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
10916 bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
10917 bit widths however.
10921 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
10922 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
10923 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
10924 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
10929 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
10930 source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
10931 '``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
10934 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
10935 intrinsics do not return a value, takes an extra isvolatile
10936 argument and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
10941 The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
10942 pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
10943 specifying the number of bytes to copy, and the fourth is a
10944 boolean indicating a volatile access.
10946 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
10947 for the first and second arguments.
10949 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
10950 is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
10951 not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
10956 The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
10957 source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
10958 copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
10959 aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
10960 otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
10964 '``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
10965 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10970 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
10971 bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
10972 support all bit widths.
10976 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
10977 i32 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
10978 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
10979 i64 <len>, i1 <isvolatile>)
10984 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
10985 particular byte value.
10987 Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
10988 intrinsic does not return a value and takes an extra volatile
10989 argument. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
10994 The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
10995 is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
10996 integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
10997 is a boolean indicating a volatile access.
10999 The :ref:`align <attr_align>` parameter attribute can be provided
11000 for the first arguments.
11002 If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
11003 a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
11004 very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
11009 The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
11010 at the destination location.
11012 '``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
11013 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11018 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
11019 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11024 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
11025 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
11026 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11027 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
11028 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11033 The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the square root of the specified value.
11038 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11043 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sqrt``' function but without
11044 trapping or setting ``errno``. For types specified by IEEE-754, the result
11045 matches a conforming libm implementation.
11047 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11048 using a less accurate calculation.
11050 '``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
11051 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11056 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
11057 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11062 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
11063 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
11064 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
11065 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
11066 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
11071 The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
11072 specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
11073 multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating-point type is
11074 used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
11079 The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
11080 raise to that power.
11085 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
11086 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
11088 '``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
11089 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11094 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
11095 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11100 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
11101 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
11102 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11103 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
11104 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11109 The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
11114 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11119 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``sin``' function but without
11120 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11122 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11123 using a less accurate calculation.
11125 '``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
11126 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11131 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
11132 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11137 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
11138 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
11139 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11140 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
11141 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11146 The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
11151 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11156 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``cos``' function but without
11157 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11159 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11160 using a less accurate calculation.
11162 '``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
11163 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11168 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
11169 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11174 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
11175 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
11176 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
11177 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
11178 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
11183 The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
11184 specified (positive or negative) power.
11189 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11194 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``pow``' function but without
11195 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11197 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11198 using a less accurate calculation.
11200 '``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
11201 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11206 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
11207 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11212 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
11213 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
11214 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11215 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
11216 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11221 The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e exponential of the specified
11227 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11232 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp``' function but without
11233 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11235 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11236 using a less accurate calculation.
11238 '``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
11239 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11244 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
11245 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11250 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
11251 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
11252 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11253 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
11254 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11259 The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 exponential of the
11265 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11270 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``exp2``' function but without
11271 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11273 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11274 using a less accurate calculation.
11276 '``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
11277 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11282 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
11283 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11288 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
11289 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
11290 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11291 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
11292 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11297 The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics compute the base-e logarithm of the specified
11303 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11308 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log``' function but without
11309 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11311 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11312 using a less accurate calculation.
11314 '``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
11315 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11320 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
11321 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11326 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
11327 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
11328 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11329 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
11330 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11335 The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics compute the base-10 logarithm of the
11341 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11346 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log10``' function but without
11347 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11349 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11350 using a less accurate calculation.
11352 '``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
11353 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11358 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
11359 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11364 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
11365 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
11366 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11367 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
11368 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11373 The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics compute the base-2 logarithm of the specified
11379 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11384 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``log2``' function but without
11385 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11387 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11388 using a less accurate calculation.
11390 '``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
11391 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11396 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
11397 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11402 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
11403 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
11404 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
11405 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
11406 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
11411 The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add operation.
11416 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same type.
11421 Return the same value as a corresponding libm '``fma``' function but without
11422 trapping or setting ``errno``.
11424 When specified with the fast-math-flag 'afn', the result may be approximated
11425 using a less accurate calculation.
11427 '``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
11428 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11433 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
11434 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11439 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
11440 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
11441 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11442 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
11443 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11448 The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
11454 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11460 This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
11461 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11463 '``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
11464 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11469 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
11470 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11475 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
11476 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11477 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11478 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11479 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11484 The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
11491 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11497 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, except for handling of
11498 signaling NaNs. This match's the behavior of libm's fmin.
11500 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
11501 NaN only if both operands are NaN. The returned NaN is always
11502 quiet. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares
11503 equal to both operands. This means that fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could
11504 return either -0.0 or 0.0.
11506 Unlike the IEEE-754 2008 behavior, this does not distinguish between
11507 signaling and quiet NaN inputs. If a target's implementation follows
11508 the standard and returns a quiet NaN if either input is a signaling
11509 NaN, the intrinsic lowering is responsible for quieting the inputs to
11510 correctly return the non-NaN input (e.g. by using the equivalent of
11511 ``llvm.canonicalize``).
11514 '``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
11515 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11520 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
11521 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11526 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
11527 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11528 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11529 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11530 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11535 The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
11542 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11547 Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum except for the handling of
11548 signaling NaNs. This matches the behavior of libm's fmax.
11550 If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
11551 NaN only if both operands are NaN. The returned NaN is always
11552 quiet. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares
11553 equal to both operands. This means that fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could
11554 return either -0.0 or 0.0.
11556 Unlike the IEEE-754 2008 behavior, this does not distinguish between
11557 signaling and quiet NaN inputs. If a target's implementation follows
11558 the standard and returns a quiet NaN if either input is a signaling
11559 NaN, the intrinsic lowering is responsible for quieting the inputs to
11560 correctly return the non-NaN input (e.g. by using the equivalent of
11561 ``llvm.canonicalize``).
11563 '``llvm.minimum.*``' Intrinsic
11564 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11569 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minimum`` on any
11570 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11575 declare float @llvm.minimum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
11576 declare double @llvm.minimum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11577 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minimum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11578 declare fp128 @llvm.minimum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11579 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minimum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11584 The '``llvm.minimum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
11585 arguments, propagating NaNs and treating -0.0 as less than +0.0.
11591 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11596 If either operand is a NaN, returns NaN. Otherwise returns the lesser
11597 of the two arguments. -0.0 is considered to be less than +0.0 for this
11598 intrinsic. Note that these are the semantics specified in the draft of
11601 '``llvm.maximum.*``' Intrinsic
11602 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11607 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maximum`` on any
11608 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11613 declare float @llvm.maximum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
11614 declare double @llvm.maximum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
11615 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maximum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
11616 declare fp128 @llvm.maximum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
11617 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maximum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
11622 The '``llvm.maximum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
11623 arguments, propagating NaNs and treating -0.0 as less than +0.0.
11629 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11634 If either operand is a NaN, returns NaN. Otherwise returns the greater
11635 of the two arguments. -0.0 is considered to be less than +0.0 for this
11636 intrinsic. Note that these are the semantics specified in the draft of
11639 '``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
11640 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11645 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
11646 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11651 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
11652 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
11653 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
11654 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
11655 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
11660 The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
11661 first operand and the sign of the second operand.
11666 The arguments and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11672 This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
11673 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11675 '``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
11676 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11681 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
11682 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11687 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
11688 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
11689 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11690 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
11691 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11696 The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
11701 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11707 This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
11708 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11710 '``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
11711 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11716 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
11717 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11722 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
11723 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
11724 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11725 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
11726 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11731 The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
11736 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11742 This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
11743 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11745 '``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
11746 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11751 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
11752 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11757 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
11758 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
11759 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11760 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
11761 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11766 The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
11767 nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
11772 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11778 This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
11779 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11781 '``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
11782 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11787 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
11788 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11793 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
11794 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
11795 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11796 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
11797 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11802 The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
11803 nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
11804 operand isn't an integer.
11809 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11815 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
11816 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11818 '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
11819 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11824 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
11825 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11830 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
11831 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
11832 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11833 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
11834 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11839 The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
11845 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11851 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
11852 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11854 '``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
11855 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11860 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
11861 floating-point or vector of floating-point type. Not all targets support
11866 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
11867 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
11868 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
11869 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
11870 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
11875 The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
11881 The argument and return value are floating-point numbers of the same
11887 This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
11888 functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
11890 Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
11891 ---------------------------
11893 LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
11894 operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
11896 '``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics
11897 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11902 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any
11907 declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
11908 declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
11909 declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
11914 The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
11915 bitpattern of an integer value; for example ``0b10110110`` becomes
11921 The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an iN value that has bit
11922 ``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output.
11924 '``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
11925 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11930 This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
11931 integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
11935 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
11936 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
11937 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
11942 The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer
11943 values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits).
11944 These are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the
11945 target's native byte order.
11950 The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
11951 and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
11952 intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
11953 swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
11954 returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
11955 ``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
11956 concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
11959 '``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
11960 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11965 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
11966 bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
11967 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
11971 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
11972 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
11973 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
11974 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
11975 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
11976 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
11981 The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
11987 The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
11988 integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
11989 match the argument type.
11994 The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
11995 each element of a vector.
11997 '``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
11998 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12003 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
12004 integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
12005 targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12009 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12010 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12011 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12012 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12013 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12014 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12019 The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
12020 leading zeros in a variable.
12025 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
12026 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
12027 type must match the first argument type.
12029 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
12030 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
12031 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
12032 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
12033 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
12038 The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
12039 zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
12040 ``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
12041 if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
12042 ``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
12044 '``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
12045 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12050 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
12051 integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12052 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12056 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12057 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12058 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12059 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12060 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12061 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
12066 The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
12072 The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
12073 any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
12074 type must match the first argument type.
12076 The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
12077 the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
12078 defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
12079 defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
12080 now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
12085 The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
12086 zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
12087 then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
12088 ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
12089 ``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
12093 '``llvm.fshl.*``' Intrinsic
12094 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12099 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fshl`` on any
12100 integer bit width or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12101 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12105 declare i8 @llvm.fshl.i8 (i8 %a, i8 %b, i8 %c)
12106 declare i67 @llvm.fshl.i67(i67 %a, i67 %b, i67 %c)
12107 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.fshl.v2i32(<2 x i32> %a, <2 x i32> %b, <2 x i32> %c)
12112 The '``llvm.fshl``' family of intrinsic functions performs a funnel shift left:
12113 the first two values are concatenated as { %a : %b } (%a is the most significant
12114 bits of the wide value), the combined value is shifted left, and the most
12115 significant bits are extracted to produce a result that is the same size as the
12116 original arguments. If the first 2 arguments are identical, this is equivalent
12117 to a rotate left operation. For vector types, the operation occurs for each
12118 element of the vector. The shift argument is treated as an unsigned amount
12119 modulo the element size of the arguments.
12124 The first two arguments are the values to be concatenated. The third
12125 argument is the shift amount. The arguments may be any integer type or a
12126 vector with integer element type. All arguments and the return value must
12127 have the same type.
12132 .. code-block:: text
12134 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 %x, i8 %y, i8 %z) ; %r = i8: msb_extract((concat(x, y) << (z % 8)), 8)
12135 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 255, i8 0, i8 15) ; %r = i8: 128 (0b10000000)
12136 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 15, i8 15, i8 11) ; %r = i8: 120 (0b01111000)
12137 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshl.i8(i8 0, i8 255, i8 8) ; %r = i8: 0 (0b00000000)
12139 '``llvm.fshr.*``' Intrinsic
12140 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12145 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fshr`` on any
12146 integer bit width or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
12147 support all bit widths or vector types, however.
12151 declare i8 @llvm.fshr.i8 (i8 %a, i8 %b, i8 %c)
12152 declare i67 @llvm.fshr.i67(i67 %a, i67 %b, i67 %c)
12153 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.fshr.v2i32(<2 x i32> %a, <2 x i32> %b, <2 x i32> %c)
12158 The '``llvm.fshr``' family of intrinsic functions performs a funnel shift right:
12159 the first two values are concatenated as { %a : %b } (%a is the most significant
12160 bits of the wide value), the combined value is shifted right, and the least
12161 significant bits are extracted to produce a result that is the same size as the
12162 original arguments. If the first 2 arguments are identical, this is equivalent
12163 to a rotate right operation. For vector types, the operation occurs for each
12164 element of the vector. The shift argument is treated as an unsigned amount
12165 modulo the element size of the arguments.
12170 The first two arguments are the values to be concatenated. The third
12171 argument is the shift amount. The arguments may be any integer type or a
12172 vector with integer element type. All arguments and the return value must
12173 have the same type.
12178 .. code-block:: text
12180 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 %x, i8 %y, i8 %z) ; %r = i8: lsb_extract((concat(x, y) >> (z % 8)), 8)
12181 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 255, i8 0, i8 15) ; %r = i8: 254 (0b11111110)
12182 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 15, i8 15, i8 11) ; %r = i8: 225 (0b11100001)
12183 %r = call i8 @llvm.fshr.i8(i8 0, i8 255, i8 8) ; %r = i8: 255 (0b11111111)
12185 Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
12186 -----------------------------------
12188 LLVM provides intrinsics for fast arithmetic overflow checking.
12190 Each of these intrinsics returns a two-element struct. The first
12191 element of this struct contains the result of the corresponding
12192 arithmetic operation modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
12193 the result. Therefore, for example, the first element of the struct
12194 returned by ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32`` is always the same as the
12195 result of a 32-bit ``add`` instruction with the same operands, where
12196 the ``add`` is *not* modified by an ``nsw`` or ``nuw`` flag.
12198 The second element of the result is an ``i1`` that is 1 if the
12199 arithmetic operation overflowed and 0 otherwise. An operation
12200 overflows if, for any values of its operands ``A`` and ``B`` and for
12201 any ``N`` larger than the operands' width, ``ext(A op B) to iN`` is
12202 not equal to ``(ext(A) to iN) op (ext(B) to iN)`` where ``ext`` is
12203 ``sext`` for signed overflow and ``zext`` for unsigned overflow, and
12204 ``op`` is the underlying arithmetic operation.
12206 The behavior of these intrinsics is well-defined for all argument
12209 '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12210 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12215 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
12216 on any integer bit width.
12220 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12221 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12222 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12227 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12228 a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
12229 occurred during the signed summation.
12234 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12235 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12236 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12237 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
12243 The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12244 a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
12245 first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
12246 of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
12252 .. code-block:: llvm
12254 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12255 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12256 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12257 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12259 '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12260 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12265 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
12266 on any integer bit width.
12270 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12271 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12272 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12277 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12278 an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
12279 occurred during the unsigned summation.
12284 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12285 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12286 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12287 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
12293 The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12294 an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
12295 first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
12296 bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
12301 .. code-block:: llvm
12303 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12304 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12305 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12306 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
12308 '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12309 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12314 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
12315 on any integer bit width.
12319 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12320 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12321 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12326 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12327 a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12328 overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
12333 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12334 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12335 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12336 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
12342 The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12343 a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
12344 first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
12345 which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
12351 .. code-block:: llvm
12353 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12354 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12355 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12356 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12358 '``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12359 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12364 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
12365 on any integer bit width.
12369 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12370 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12371 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12376 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12377 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12378 overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
12383 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12384 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12385 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12386 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
12392 The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12393 an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
12394 the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
12395 which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
12401 .. code-block:: llvm
12403 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12404 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12405 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12406 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12408 '``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12409 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12414 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
12415 on any integer bit width.
12419 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12420 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12421 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12426 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12427 a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12428 overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
12433 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12434 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12435 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12436 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
12442 The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12443 a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
12444 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
12445 of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
12451 .. code-block:: llvm
12453 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12454 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12455 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12456 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12458 '``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
12459 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12464 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
12465 on any integer bit width.
12469 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
12470 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12471 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
12476 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12477 a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
12478 overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
12483 The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
12484 may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
12485 bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
12486 ``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
12492 The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
12493 an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
12494 the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
12495 element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
12496 resulted in an overflow.
12501 .. code-block:: llvm
12503 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
12504 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
12505 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
12506 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
12508 Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
12509 ---------------------------------
12511 '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic
12512 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12519 declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
12520 declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
12525 The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
12526 encoding of a floating-point number. This canonicalization is useful for
12527 implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
12528 defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
12532 2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
12533 representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
12534 numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
12536 This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008
12537 conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled
12538 according to section 6.2.
12540 Examples of non-canonical encodings:
12542 - x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are
12543 converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
12544 - Many normal decimal floating-point numbers have non-canonical alternative
12546 - Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values.
12547 These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and will be flushed to
12548 a zero of the same sign by this operation.
12550 Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with
12551 default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a
12554 This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
12555 that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
12556 1.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with
12557 -0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
12559 ``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is:
12561 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)``
12562 - ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to
12565 Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
12566 ``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0``
12568 The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions.
12569 First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN
12570 must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the
12573 The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
12575 - The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a
12576 floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
12577 - The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point
12578 operations. That is, the bits of the floating-point value are not examined.
12580 '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
12581 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12588 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
12589 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
12594 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
12595 expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
12596 target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
12597 fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
12598 and add instructions.
12603 The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
12604 multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
12613 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
12615 is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
12616 not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
12617 code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
12618 the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
12619 corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
12620 instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
12625 .. code-block:: llvm
12627 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
12630 Experimental Vector Reduction Intrinsics
12631 ----------------------------------------
12633 Horizontal reductions of vectors can be expressed using the following
12634 intrinsics. Each one takes a vector operand as an input and applies its
12635 respective operation across all elements of the vector, returning a single
12636 scalar result of the same element type.
12639 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' Intrinsic
12640 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12647 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12648 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.i64.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
12653 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.add.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``ADD``
12654 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
12655 the element-type of the vector input.
12659 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12661 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.*``' Intrinsic
12662 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12669 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %a)
12670 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f64.v2f64(double %acc, <2 x double> %a)
12675 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
12676 ``ADD`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12677 matches the element-type of the vector input.
12679 If the intrinsic call has fast-math flags, then the reduction will not preserve
12680 the associativity of an equivalent scalarized counterpart. If it does not have
12681 fast-math flags, then the reduction will be *ordered*, implying that the
12682 operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
12687 The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar accumulator value, which is
12688 only used when there are no fast-math flags attached. This argument may be undef
12689 when fast-math flags are used.
12691 The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
12696 .. code-block:: llvm
12698 %fast = call fast float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float undef, <4 x float> %input) ; fast reduction
12699 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fadd.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
12702 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' Intrinsic
12703 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12710 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12711 declare i64 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.i64.v2i64(<2 x i64> %a)
12716 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.mul.*``' intrinsics do an integer ``MUL``
12717 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
12718 the element-type of the vector input.
12722 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12724 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.*``' Intrinsic
12725 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12732 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %a)
12733 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f64.v2f64(double %acc, <2 x double> %a)
12738 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
12739 ``MUL`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12740 matches the element-type of the vector input.
12742 If the intrinsic call has fast-math flags, then the reduction will not preserve
12743 the associativity of an equivalent scalarized counterpart. If it does not have
12744 fast-math flags, then the reduction will be *ordered*, implying that the
12745 operation respects the associativity of a scalarized reduction.
12750 The first argument to this intrinsic is a scalar accumulator value, which is
12751 only used when there are no fast-math flags attached. This argument may be undef
12752 when fast-math flags are used.
12754 The second argument must be a vector of floating-point values.
12759 .. code-block:: llvm
12761 %fast = call fast float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float undef, <4 x float> %input) ; fast reduction
12762 %ord = call float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmul.f32.v4f32(float %acc, <4 x float> %input) ; ordered reduction
12764 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' Intrinsic
12765 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12772 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12777 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.and.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``AND``
12778 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
12779 the element-type of the vector input.
12783 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12785 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' Intrinsic
12786 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12793 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12798 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.or.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``OR`` reduction
12799 of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches the
12800 element-type of the vector input.
12804 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12806 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' Intrinsic
12807 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12814 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12819 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.xor.*``' intrinsics do a bitwise ``XOR``
12820 reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type matches
12821 the element-type of the vector input.
12825 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12827 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' Intrinsic
12828 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12835 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12840 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smax.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
12841 ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12842 matches the element-type of the vector input.
12846 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12848 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' Intrinsic
12849 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12856 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12861 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.smin.*``' intrinsics do a signed integer
12862 ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12863 matches the element-type of the vector input.
12867 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12869 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' Intrinsic
12870 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12877 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12882 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umax.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
12883 integer ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
12884 return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
12888 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12890 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' Intrinsic
12891 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12898 declare i32 @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.i32.v4i32(<4 x i32> %a)
12903 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.umin.*``' intrinsics do an unsigned
12904 integer ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The
12905 return type matches the element-type of the vector input.
12909 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of integer values.
12911 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' Intrinsic
12912 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12919 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.f32.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
12920 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.f64.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
12925 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmax.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
12926 ``MAX`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12927 matches the element-type of the vector input.
12929 If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
12930 assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
12934 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
12936 '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' Intrinsic
12937 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12944 declare float @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.f32.v4f32(<4 x float> %a)
12945 declare double @llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.f64.v2f64(<2 x double> %a)
12950 The '``llvm.experimental.vector.reduce.fmin.*``' intrinsics do a floating-point
12951 ``MIN`` reduction of a vector, returning the result as a scalar. The return type
12952 matches the element-type of the vector input.
12954 If the intrinsic call has the ``nnan`` fast-math flag then the operation can
12955 assume that NaNs are not present in the input vector.
12959 The argument to this intrinsic must be a vector of floating-point values.
12961 Half Precision Floating-Point Intrinsics
12962 ----------------------------------------
12964 For most target platforms, half precision floating-point is a
12965 storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
12966 but does not support computation in the format.
12968 This means that code must first load the half-precision floating-point
12969 value as an i16, then convert it to float with
12970 :ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
12971 then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
12972 etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
12973 if needed, then converted to i16 with
12974 :ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
12977 .. _int_convert_to_fp16:
12979 '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
12980 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12987 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
12988 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
12993 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
12994 conventional floating-point type to half precision floating-point format.
12999 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
13005 The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
13006 conventional floating-point format to half precision floating-point format. The
13007 return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
13012 .. code-block:: llvm
13014 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
13015 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
13017 .. _int_convert_from_fp16:
13019 '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
13020 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13027 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
13028 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
13033 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
13034 conversion from half precision floating-point format to single precision
13035 floating-point format.
13040 The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
13046 The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
13047 conversion from half single precision floating-point format to single
13048 precision floating-point format. The input half-float value is
13049 represented by an ``i16`` value.
13054 .. code-block:: llvm
13056 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
13057 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
13059 .. _dbg_intrinsics:
13061 Debugger Intrinsics
13062 -------------------
13064 The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
13065 prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
13066 Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_
13069 Exception Handling Intrinsics
13070 -----------------------------
13072 The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
13073 ``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
13074 Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format-common-intrinsics>`_ document.
13076 .. _int_trampoline:
13078 Trampoline Intrinsics
13079 ---------------------
13081 These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
13082 the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
13083 callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
13084 not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
13085 in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
13086 stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
13087 argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
13090 For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
13091 then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
13092 It can be created as follows:
13094 .. code-block:: llvm
13096 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
13097 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
13098 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
13099 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
13100 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
13102 The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
13103 ``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
13107 '``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
13108 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13115 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
13120 This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
13121 turning it into a trampoline.
13126 The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
13127 pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
13128 sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
13129 intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
13130 LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
13131 front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
13132 target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
13133 bitcast to an ``i8*``.
13138 The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
13139 dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
13140 passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
13141 be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
13142 function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
13143 marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
13144 argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
13145 function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
13146 but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
13147 calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
13148 modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
13149 pointer is undefined.
13153 '``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
13154 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13161 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
13166 This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
13167 a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
13172 ``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
13173 code filled in by a previous call to
13174 :ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
13179 On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
13180 different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
13181 intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
13182 after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
13183 returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
13185 .. _int_mload_mstore:
13187 Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
13188 ---------------------------------------
13190 LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
13194 '``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
13195 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13199 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
13203 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
13204 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64.p0v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
13205 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
13206 declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
13207 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
13208 declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f.p0v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
13213 Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
13219 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
13225 The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
13226 The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
13231 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
13233 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
13234 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
13235 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
13239 '``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
13240 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13244 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type.
13248 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32.p0v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
13249 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
13250 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
13251 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
13252 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
13253 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f.p0v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
13258 Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
13263 The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
13269 The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
13270 The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
13274 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
13276 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
13277 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
13278 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
13279 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
13282 Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
13283 -------------------------------------------
13285 LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
13289 '``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
13290 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13294 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
13298 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32.v16p0f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
13299 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64.v2p1f64 (<2 x double addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
13300 declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32.v8p0p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
13305 Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
13311 The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
13317 The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
13318 The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
13323 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1> <i1 true, i1 true, i1 true, i1 true>, <4 x double> undef)
13325 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
13326 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
13327 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
13328 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
13329 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
13331 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
13332 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
13333 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
13334 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
13336 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
13337 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
13338 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
13339 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
13343 '``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
13344 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13348 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating-point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
13352 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
13353 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32.v16p1f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float addrspace(1)*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
13354 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64.v4p0p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
13359 Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
13364 The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
13370 The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
13374 ;; This instruction unconditionally stores data vector in multiple addresses
13375 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32.v8p0i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
13377 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
13378 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
13379 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
13381 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
13382 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
13383 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
13385 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
13386 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
13387 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
13388 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
13390 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
13393 Masked Vector Expanding Load and Compressing Store Intrinsics
13394 -------------------------------------------------------------
13396 LLVM provides intrinsics for expanding load and compressing store operations. Data selected from a vector according to a mask is stored in consecutive memory addresses (compressed store), and vice-versa (expanding load). These operations effective map to "if (cond.i) a[j++] = v.i" and "if (cond.i) v.i = a[j++]" patterns, respectively. Note that when the mask starts with '1' bits followed by '0' bits, these operations are identical to :ref:`llvm.masked.store <int_mstore>` and :ref:`llvm.masked.load <int_mload>`.
13398 .. _int_expandload:
13400 '``llvm.masked.expandload.*``' Intrinsics
13401 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13405 This is an overloaded intrinsic. Several values of integer, floating point or pointer data type are loaded from consecutive memory addresses and stored into the elements of a vector according to the mask.
13409 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.expandload.v16f32 (float* <ptr>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
13410 declare <2 x i64> @llvm.masked.expandload.v2i64 (i64* <ptr>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x i64> <passthru>)
13415 Reads a number of scalar values sequentially from memory location provided in '``ptr``' and spreads them in a vector. The '``mask``' holds a bit for each vector lane. The number of elements read from memory is equal to the number of '1' bits in the mask. The loaded elements are positioned in the destination vector according to the sequence of '1' and '0' bits in the mask. E.g., if the mask vector is '10010001', "explandload" reads 3 values from memory addresses ptr, ptr+1, ptr+2 and places them in lanes 0, 3 and 7 accordingly. The masked-off lanes are filled by elements from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
13421 The first operand is the base pointer for the load. It has the same underlying type as the element of the returned vector. The second operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The third is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type and the type of the '``passthru``' operand have the same vector type.
13426 The '``llvm.masked.expandload``' intrinsic is designed for reading multiple scalar values from adjacent memory addresses into possibly non-adjacent vector lanes. It is useful for targets that support vector expanding loads and allows vectorizing loop with cross-iteration dependency like in the following example:
13430 // In this loop we load from B and spread the elements into array A.
13431 double *A, B; int *C;
13432 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
13438 .. code-block:: llvm
13440 ; Load several elements from array B and expand them in a vector.
13441 ; The number of loaded elements is equal to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
13442 %Tmp = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.expandload.v8f64(double* %Bptr, <8 x i1> %Mask, <8 x double> undef)
13443 ; Store the result in A
13444 call void @llvm.masked.store.v8f64.p0v8f64(<8 x double> %Tmp, <8 x double>* %Aptr, i32 8, <8 x i1> %Mask)
13446 ; %Bptr should be increased on each iteration according to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
13447 %MaskI = bitcast <8 x i1> %Mask to i8
13448 %MaskIPopcnt = call i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %MaskI)
13449 %MaskI64 = zext i8 %MaskIPopcnt to i64
13450 %BNextInd = add i64 %BInd, %MaskI64
13453 Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example, by lowering it into a sequence of conditional scalar load operations and shuffles.
13454 If all mask elements are '1', the intrinsic behavior is equivalent to the regular unmasked vector load.
13456 .. _int_compressstore:
13458 '``llvm.masked.compressstore.*``' Intrinsics
13459 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13463 This is an overloaded intrinsic. A number of scalar values of integer, floating point or pointer data type are collected from an input vector and stored into adjacent memory addresses. A mask defines which elements to collect from the vector.
13467 declare void @llvm.masked.compressstore.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, i32* <ptr>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
13468 declare void @llvm.masked.compressstore.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, float* <ptr>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
13473 Selects elements from input vector '``value``' according to the '``mask``'. All selected elements are written into adjacent memory addresses starting at address '`ptr`', from lower to higher. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to select elements to be stored. The number of elements to be stored is equal to the number of active bits in the mask.
13478 The first operand is the input vector, from which elements are collected and written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the element of the input vector operand. The third operand is the mask, a vector of boolean values. The mask and the input vector must have the same number of vector elements.
13484 The '``llvm.masked.compressstore``' intrinsic is designed for compressing data in memory. It allows to collect elements from possibly non-adjacent lanes of a vector and store them contiguously in memory in one IR operation. It is useful for targets that support compressing store operations and allows vectorizing loops with cross-iteration dependences like in the following example:
13488 // In this loop we load elements from A and store them consecutively in B
13489 double *A, B; int *C;
13490 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
13496 .. code-block:: llvm
13498 ; Load elements from A.
13499 %Tmp = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v8f64.p0v8f64(<8 x double>* %Aptr, i32 8, <8 x i1> %Mask, <8 x double> undef)
13500 ; Store all selected elements consecutively in array B
13501 call <void> @llvm.masked.compressstore.v8f64(<8 x double> %Tmp, double* %Bptr, <8 x i1> %Mask)
13503 ; %Bptr should be increased on each iteration according to the number of '1' elements in the Mask.
13504 %MaskI = bitcast <8 x i1> %Mask to i8
13505 %MaskIPopcnt = call i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %MaskI)
13506 %MaskI64 = zext i8 %MaskIPopcnt to i64
13507 %BNextInd = add i64 %BInd, %MaskI64
13510 Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example, by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
13516 This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
13517 memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
13521 '``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
13522 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13529 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
13534 The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
13540 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
13541 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
13547 This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
13548 of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
13549 to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
13550 that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
13554 '``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
13555 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13562 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
13567 The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
13573 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
13574 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
13580 This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
13581 the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
13582 never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
13583 object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
13585 '``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
13586 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13590 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
13594 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start.p0i8(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
13599 The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
13600 a memory object will not change.
13605 The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
13606 object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
13612 This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
13613 the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
13616 '``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
13617 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13621 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
13625 declare void @llvm.invariant.end.p0i8({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
13630 The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
13631 memory object are mutable.
13636 The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
13637 The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
13638 object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
13639 pointer to the object.
13644 This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
13646 '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
13647 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13651 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
13652 space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
13657 declare i8* @llvm.launder.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
13662 The '``llvm.launder.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
13663 established by ``invariant.group`` metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new
13664 pointer value that carries fresh invariant group information. It is an
13665 experimental intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the
13672 The ``llvm.launder.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is a pointer
13678 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different
13679 for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata.
13680 It does not read any accessible memory and the execution can be speculated.
13682 '``llvm.strip.invariant.group``' Intrinsic
13683 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13687 This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address
13688 space. The returned pointer must belong to the same address space as the
13693 declare i8* @llvm.strip.invariant.group.p0i8(i8* <ptr>)
13698 The '``llvm.strip.invariant.group``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
13699 established by ``invariant.group`` metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
13700 value that does not carry the invariant information. It is an experimental
13701 intrinsic, which means that its semantics might change in the future.
13707 The ``llvm.strip.invariant.group`` takes only one argument, which is a pointer
13713 Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which has no associated
13714 ``invariant.group`` metadata.
13715 It does not read any memory and can be speculated.
13721 Constrained Floating-Point Intrinsics
13722 -------------------------------------
13724 These intrinsics are used to provide special handling of floating-point
13725 operations when specific rounding mode or floating-point exception behavior is
13726 required. By default, LLVM optimization passes assume that the rounding mode is
13727 round-to-nearest and that floating-point exceptions will not be monitored.
13728 Constrained FP intrinsics are used to support non-default rounding modes and
13729 accurately preserve exception behavior without compromising LLVM's ability to
13730 optimize FP code when the default behavior is used.
13732 Each of these intrinsics corresponds to a normal floating-point operation. The
13733 first two arguments and the return value are the same as the corresponding FP
13736 The third argument is a metadata argument specifying the rounding mode to be
13737 assumed. This argument must be one of the following strings:
13747 If this argument is "round.dynamic" optimization passes must assume that the
13748 rounding mode is unknown and may change at runtime. No transformations that
13749 depend on rounding mode may be performed in this case.
13751 The other possible values for the rounding mode argument correspond to the
13752 similarly named IEEE rounding modes. If the argument is any of these values
13753 optimization passes may perform transformations as long as they are consistent
13754 with the specified rounding mode.
13756 For example, 'x-0'->'x' is not a valid transformation if the rounding mode is
13757 "round.downward" or "round.dynamic" because if the value of 'x' is +0 then
13758 'x-0' should evaluate to '-0' when rounding downward. However, this
13759 transformation is legal for all other rounding modes.
13761 For values other than "round.dynamic" optimization passes may assume that the
13762 actual runtime rounding mode (as defined in a target-specific manner) matches
13763 the specified rounding mode, but this is not guaranteed. Using a specific
13764 non-dynamic rounding mode which does not match the actual rounding mode at
13765 runtime results in undefined behavior.
13767 The fourth argument to the constrained floating-point intrinsics specifies the
13768 required exception behavior. This argument must be one of the following
13777 If this argument is "fpexcept.ignore" optimization passes may assume that the
13778 exception status flags will not be read and that floating-point exceptions will
13779 be masked. This allows transformations to be performed that may change the
13780 exception semantics of the original code. For example, FP operations may be
13781 speculatively executed in this case whereas they must not be for either of the
13782 other possible values of this argument.
13784 If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.maytrap" optimization passes
13785 must avoid transformations that may raise exceptions that would not have been
13786 raised by the original code (such as speculatively executing FP operations), but
13787 passes are not required to preserve all exceptions that are implied by the
13788 original code. For example, exceptions may be potentially hidden by constant
13791 If the exception behavior argument is "fpexcept.strict" all transformations must
13792 strictly preserve the floating-point exception semantics of the original code.
13793 Any FP exception that would have been raised by the original code must be raised
13794 by the transformed code, and the transformed code must not raise any FP
13795 exceptions that would not have been raised by the original code. This is the
13796 exception behavior argument that will be used if the code being compiled reads
13797 the FP exception status flags, but this mode can also be used with code that
13798 unmasks FP exceptions.
13800 The number and order of floating-point exceptions is NOT guaranteed. For
13801 example, a series of FP operations that each may raise exceptions may be
13802 vectorized into a single instruction that raises each unique exception a single
13806 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' Intrinsic
13807 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13815 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13816 metadata <rounding mode>,
13817 metadata <exception behavior>)
13822 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``' intrinsic returns the sum of its
13829 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fadd``'
13830 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13831 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
13833 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13834 behavior as described above.
13839 The value produced is the floating-point sum of the two value operands and has
13840 the same type as the operands.
13843 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' Intrinsic
13844 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13852 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13853 metadata <rounding mode>,
13854 metadata <exception behavior>)
13859 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``' intrinsic returns the difference
13860 of its two operands.
13866 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fsub``'
13867 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13868 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
13870 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13871 behavior as described above.
13876 The value produced is the floating-point difference of the two value operands
13877 and has the same type as the operands.
13880 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' Intrinsic
13881 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13889 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13890 metadata <rounding mode>,
13891 metadata <exception behavior>)
13896 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``' intrinsic returns the product of
13903 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fmul``'
13904 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13905 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
13907 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13908 behavior as described above.
13913 The value produced is the floating-point product of the two value operands and
13914 has the same type as the operands.
13917 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' Intrinsic
13918 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13926 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13927 metadata <rounding mode>,
13928 metadata <exception behavior>)
13933 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``' intrinsic returns the quotient of
13940 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fdiv``'
13941 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13942 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
13944 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13945 behavior as described above.
13950 The value produced is the floating-point quotient of the two value operands and
13951 has the same type as the operands.
13954 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' Intrinsic
13955 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
13963 @llvm.experimental.constrained.frem(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
13964 metadata <rounding mode>,
13965 metadata <exception behavior>)
13970 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``' intrinsic returns the remainder
13971 from the division of its two operands.
13977 The first two arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.frem``'
13978 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>`
13979 of floating-point values. Both arguments must have identical types.
13981 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
13982 behavior as described above. The rounding mode argument has no effect, since
13983 the result of frem is never rounded, but the argument is included for
13984 consistency with the other constrained floating-point intrinsics.
13989 The value produced is the floating-point remainder from the division of the two
13990 value operands and has the same type as the operands. The remainder has the
13991 same sign as the dividend.
13993 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' Intrinsic
13994 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14002 @llvm.experimental.constrained.fma(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>, <type> <op3>,
14003 metadata <rounding mode>,
14004 metadata <exception behavior>)
14009 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``' intrinsic returns the result of a
14010 fused-multiply-add operation on its operands.
14015 The first three arguments to the '``llvm.experimental.constrained.fma``'
14016 intrinsic must be :ref:`floating-point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector
14017 <t_vector>` of floating-point values. All arguments must have identical types.
14019 The fourth and fifth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception behavior
14020 as described above.
14025 The result produced is the product of the first two operands added to the third
14026 operand computed with infinite precision, and then rounded to the target
14029 Constrained libm-equivalent Intrinsics
14030 --------------------------------------
14032 In addition to the basic floating-point operations for which constrained
14033 intrinsics are described above, there are constrained versions of various
14034 operations which provide equivalent behavior to a corresponding libm function.
14035 These intrinsics allow the precise behavior of these operations with respect to
14036 rounding mode and exception behavior to be controlled.
14038 As with the basic constrained floating-point intrinsics, the rounding mode
14039 and exception behavior arguments only control the behavior of the optimizer.
14040 They do not change the runtime floating-point environment.
14043 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' Intrinsic
14044 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14052 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt(<type> <op1>,
14053 metadata <rounding mode>,
14054 metadata <exception behavior>)
14059 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sqrt``' intrinsic returns the square root
14060 of the specified value, returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``'
14061 functions would, but without setting ``errno``.
14066 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
14069 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14070 behavior as described above.
14075 This function returns the nonnegative square root of the specified value.
14076 If the value is less than negative zero, a floating-point exception occurs
14077 and the return value is architecture specific.
14080 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' Intrinsic
14081 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14089 @llvm.experimental.constrained.pow(<type> <op1>, <type> <op2>,
14090 metadata <rounding mode>,
14091 metadata <exception behavior>)
14096 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.pow``' intrinsic returns the first operand
14097 raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand.
14102 The first two arguments and the return value are floating-point numbers of the
14103 same type. The second argument specifies the power to which the first argument
14106 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14107 behavior as described above.
14112 This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
14113 returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
14114 handles error conditions in the same way.
14117 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' Intrinsic
14118 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14126 @llvm.experimental.constrained.powi(<type> <op1>, i32 <op2>,
14127 metadata <rounding mode>,
14128 metadata <exception behavior>)
14133 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.powi``' intrinsic returns the first operand
14134 raised to the (positive or negative) power specified by the second operand. The
14135 order of evaluation of multiplications is not defined. When a vector of
14136 floating-point type is used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
14142 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14143 type. The second argument is a 32-bit signed integer specifying the power to
14144 which the first argument should be raised.
14146 The third and fourth arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14147 behavior as described above.
14152 This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
14153 unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
14156 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' Intrinsic
14157 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14165 @llvm.experimental.constrained.sin(<type> <op1>,
14166 metadata <rounding mode>,
14167 metadata <exception behavior>)
14172 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.sin``' intrinsic returns the sine of the
14178 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
14181 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14182 behavior as described above.
14187 This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
14188 same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
14189 conditions in the same way.
14192 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' Intrinsic
14193 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14201 @llvm.experimental.constrained.cos(<type> <op1>,
14202 metadata <rounding mode>,
14203 metadata <exception behavior>)
14208 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.cos``' intrinsic returns the cosine of the
14214 The first argument and the return type are floating-point numbers of the same
14217 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14218 behavior as described above.
14223 This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
14224 same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
14225 conditions in the same way.
14228 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' Intrinsic
14229 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14237 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp(<type> <op1>,
14238 metadata <rounding mode>,
14239 metadata <exception behavior>)
14244 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp``' intrinsic computes the base-e
14245 exponential of the specified value.
14250 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14253 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14254 behavior as described above.
14259 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
14260 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
14263 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' Intrinsic
14264 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14272 @llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2(<type> <op1>,
14273 metadata <rounding mode>,
14274 metadata <exception behavior>)
14279 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.exp2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
14280 exponential of the specified value.
14286 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14289 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14290 behavior as described above.
14295 This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
14296 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
14299 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' Intrinsic
14300 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14308 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log(<type> <op1>,
14309 metadata <rounding mode>,
14310 metadata <exception behavior>)
14315 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log``' intrinsic computes the base-e
14316 logarithm of the specified value.
14321 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14324 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14325 behavior as described above.
14331 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
14332 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
14335 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' Intrinsic
14336 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14344 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log10(<type> <op1>,
14345 metadata <rounding mode>,
14346 metadata <exception behavior>)
14351 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log10``' intrinsic computes the base-10
14352 logarithm of the specified value.
14357 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14360 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14361 behavior as described above.
14366 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
14367 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
14370 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' Intrinsic
14371 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14379 @llvm.experimental.constrained.log2(<type> <op1>,
14380 metadata <rounding mode>,
14381 metadata <exception behavior>)
14386 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.log2``' intrinsic computes the base-2
14387 logarithm of the specified value.
14392 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14395 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14396 behavior as described above.
14401 This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
14402 would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
14405 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' Intrinsic
14406 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14414 @llvm.experimental.constrained.rint(<type> <op1>,
14415 metadata <rounding mode>,
14416 metadata <exception behavior>)
14421 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.rint``' intrinsic returns the first
14422 operand rounded to the nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point
14423 exception if the operand is not an integer.
14428 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14431 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14432 behavior as described above.
14437 This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
14438 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
14439 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
14440 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
14441 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
14444 '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' Intrinsic
14445 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14453 @llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint(<type> <op1>,
14454 metadata <rounding mode>,
14455 metadata <exception behavior>)
14460 The '``llvm.experimental.constrained.nearbyint``' intrinsic returns the first
14461 operand rounded to the nearest integer. It will not raise an inexact
14462 floating-point exception if the operand is not an integer.
14468 The first argument and the return value are floating-point numbers of the same
14471 The second and third arguments specify the rounding mode and exception
14472 behavior as described above.
14477 This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint`` functions
14478 would, and handles error conditions in the same way. The rounding mode is
14479 described, not determined, by the rounding mode argument. The actual rounding
14480 mode is determined by the runtime floating-point environment. The rounding
14481 mode argument is only intended as information to the compiler.
14487 This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
14490 '``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
14491 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14498 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14503 The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
14508 The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
14509 global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
14510 source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
14515 This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
14516 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
14517 to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
14518 ignored by code generation and optimization.
14520 '``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
14521 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14526 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
14527 pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
14528 the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
14533 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14534 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14535 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14536 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14537 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14542 The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
14547 The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
14548 (result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
14549 third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
14550 last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
14555 This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
14556 strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
14557 for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
14558 generation and optimization.
14560 '``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
14561 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14566 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
14567 any integer bit width.
14571 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14572 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14573 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14574 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14575 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
14580 The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
14585 The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
14586 second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
14587 global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
14588 the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
14593 This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
14594 with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
14595 optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
14596 other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
14598 '``llvm.codeview.annotation``' Intrinsic
14599 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14604 This annotation emits a label at its program point and an associated
14605 ``S_ANNOTATION`` codeview record with some additional string metadata. This is
14606 used to implement MSVC's ``__annotation`` intrinsic. It is marked
14607 ``noduplicate``, so calls to this intrinsic prevent inlining and should be
14608 considered expensive.
14612 declare void @llvm.codeview.annotation(metadata)
14617 The argument should be an MDTuple containing any number of MDStrings.
14619 '``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
14620 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14627 declare void @llvm.trap() noreturn nounwind
14632 The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
14642 This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
14643 the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
14644 lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
14646 '``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
14647 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14654 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
14659 The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
14669 This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
14670 execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
14673 '``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
14674 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14681 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
14686 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
14687 onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
14688 is placed on the stack before local variables.
14693 The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
14694 The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
14695 ``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
14696 enough space to hold the value of the guard.
14701 This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
14702 the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
14703 to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
14704 the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
14705 checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
14706 different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
14707 calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
14709 '``llvm.stackguard``' Intrinsic
14710 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14717 declare i8* @llvm.stackguard()
14722 The ``llvm.stackguard`` intrinsic returns the system stack guard value.
14724 It should not be generated by frontends, since it is only for internal usage.
14725 The reason why we create this intrinsic is that we still support IR form Stack
14726 Protector in FastISel.
14736 On some platforms, the value returned by this intrinsic remains unchanged
14737 between loads in the same thread. On other platforms, it returns the same
14738 global variable value, if any, e.g. ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
14740 Currently some platforms have IR-level customized stack guard loading (e.g.
14741 X86 Linux) that is not handled by ``llvm.stackguard()``, while they should be
14744 '``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
14745 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14752 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>)
14753 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>, i1 <nullunknown>)
14758 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to
14759 the optimizers to determine at compile time whether a) an operation
14760 (like memcpy) will overflow a buffer that corresponds to an object, or
14761 b) that a runtime check for overflow isn't necessary. An object in this
14762 context means an allocation of a specific class, structure, array, or
14768 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes three arguments. The first argument is
14769 a pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument determines whether
14770 ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true) or -1 (if false) when the object size
14771 is unknown. The third argument controls how ``llvm.objectsize`` acts when
14772 ``null`` in address space 0 is used as its pointer argument. If it's ``false``,
14773 ``llvm.objectsize`` reports 0 bytes available when given ``null``. Otherwise, if
14774 the ``null`` is in a non-zero address space or if ``true`` is given for the
14775 third argument of ``llvm.objectsize``, we assume its size is unknown.
14777 The second and third arguments only accept constants.
14782 The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a constant representing
14783 the size of the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined at
14784 compile time, ``llvm.objectsize`` returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending
14785 on the ``min`` argument).
14787 '``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
14788 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14793 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
14798 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
14799 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
14800 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
14805 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
14806 most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
14811 The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
14812 a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a
14813 constant value, variables are not allowed.
14818 This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
14822 '``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
14823 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14830 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
14835 The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
14836 condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
14842 The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
14847 The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
14848 always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
14849 generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
14850 provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
14851 violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
14853 Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
14854 used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
14855 only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
14856 if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
14857 sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
14858 ``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
14859 that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
14864 '``llvm.ssa_copy``' Intrinsic
14865 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14872 declare type @llvm.ssa_copy(type %operand) returned(1) readnone
14877 The first argument is an operand which is used as the returned value.
14882 The ``llvm.ssa_copy`` intrinsic can be used to attach information to
14883 operations by copying them and giving them new names. For example,
14884 the PredicateInfo utility uses it to build Extended SSA form, and
14885 attach various forms of information to operands that dominate specific
14886 uses. It is not meant for general use, only for building temporary
14887 renaming forms that require value splits at certain points.
14891 '``llvm.type.test``' Intrinsic
14892 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14899 declare i1 @llvm.type.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %type) nounwind readnone
14905 The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
14906 metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier <TypeMetadata>`.
14911 The ``llvm.type.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is associated
14912 with the given type identifier.
14914 '``llvm.type.checked.load``' Intrinsic
14915 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14922 declare {i8*, i1} @llvm.type.checked.load(i8* %ptr, i32 %offset, metadata %type) argmemonly nounwind readonly
14928 The first argument is a pointer from which to load a function pointer. The
14929 second argument is the byte offset from which to load the function pointer. The
14930 third argument is a metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier
14936 The ``llvm.type.checked.load`` intrinsic safely loads a function pointer from a
14937 virtual table pointer using type metadata. This intrinsic is used to implement
14938 control flow integrity in conjunction with virtual call optimization. The
14939 virtual call optimization pass will optimize away ``llvm.type.checked.load``
14940 intrinsics associated with devirtualized calls, thereby removing the type
14941 check in cases where it is not needed to enforce the control flow integrity
14944 If the given pointer is associated with a type metadata identifier, this
14945 function returns true as the second element of its return value. (Note that
14946 the function may also return true if the given pointer is not associated
14947 with a type metadata identifier.) If the function's return value's second
14948 element is true, the following rules apply to the first element:
14950 - If the given pointer is associated with the given type metadata identifier,
14951 it is the function pointer loaded from the given byte offset from the given
14954 - If the given pointer is not associated with the given type metadata
14955 identifier, it is one of the following (the choice of which is unspecified):
14957 1. The function pointer that would have been loaded from an arbitrarily chosen
14958 (through an unspecified mechanism) pointer associated with the type
14961 2. If the function has a non-void return type, a pointer to a function that
14962 returns an unspecified value without causing side effects.
14964 If the function's return value's second element is false, the value of the
14965 first element is undefined.
14968 '``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
14969 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
14976 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
14981 The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
14982 three intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint`` and
14983 ``llvm.experimental.gc.statepoint``) that can be called with an invoke
14994 This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
14997 '``llvm.experimental.deoptimize``' Intrinsic
14998 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15005 declare type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
15010 This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
15011 <deopt_opbundles>`, allow frontends to express transfer of control and
15012 frame-local state from the currently executing (typically more specialized,
15013 hence faster) version of a function into another (typically more generic, hence
15016 In languages with a fully integrated managed runtime like Java and JavaScript
15017 this intrinsic can be used to implement "uncommon trap" or "side exit" like
15018 functionality. In unmanaged languages like C and C++, this intrinsic can be
15019 used to represent the slow paths of specialized functions.
15025 The intrinsic takes an arbitrary number of arguments, whose meaning is
15026 decided by the :ref:`lowering strategy<deoptimize_lowering>`.
15031 The ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` intrinsic executes an attached
15032 deoptimization continuation (denoted using a :ref:`deoptimization
15033 operand bundle <deopt_opbundles>`) and returns the value returned by
15034 the deoptimization continuation. Defining the semantic properties of
15035 the continuation itself is out of scope of the language reference --
15036 as far as LLVM is concerned, the deoptimization continuation can
15037 invoke arbitrary side effects, including reading from and writing to
15040 Deoptimization continuations expressed using ``"deopt"`` operand bundles always
15041 continue execution to the end of the physical frame containing them, so all
15042 calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must be in "tail position":
15044 - ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` cannot be invoked.
15045 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction.
15046 - The ``ret`` instruction must return the value produced by the
15047 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` call if there is one, or void.
15049 Note that the above restrictions imply that the return type for a call to
15050 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` will match the return type of its immediate
15053 The inliner composes the ``"deopt"`` continuations of the caller into the
15054 ``"deopt"`` continuations present in the inlinee, and also updates calls to this
15055 intrinsic to return directly from the frame of the function it inlined into.
15057 All declarations of ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must share the
15058 same calling convention.
15060 .. _deoptimize_lowering:
15065 Calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered to calls to the
15066 symbol ``__llvm_deoptimize`` (it is the frontend's responsibility to
15067 ensure that this symbol is defined). The call arguments to
15068 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered as if they were formal
15069 arguments of the specified types, and not as varargs.
15072 '``llvm.experimental.guard``' Intrinsic
15073 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15080 declare void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1, ...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
15085 This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
15086 <deopt_opbundles>`, allows frontends to express guards or checks on
15087 optimistic assumptions made during compilation. The semantics of
15088 ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` is defined in terms of
15089 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` -- its body is defined to be
15092 .. code-block:: text
15094 define void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %pred, <args...>) {
15095 %realPred = and i1 %pred, undef
15096 br i1 %realPred, label %continue, label %leave [, !make.implicit !{}]
15099 call void @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"() ]
15107 with the optional ``[, !make.implicit !{}]`` present if and only if it
15108 is present on the call site. For more details on ``!make.implicit``,
15109 see :doc:`FaultMaps`.
15111 In words, ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` executes the attached
15112 ``"deopt"`` continuation if (but **not** only if) its first argument
15113 is ``false``. Since the optimizer is allowed to replace the ``undef``
15114 with an arbitrary value, it can optimize guard to fail "spuriously",
15115 i.e. without the original condition being false (hence the "not only
15116 if"); and this allows for "check widening" type optimizations.
15118 ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` cannot be invoked.
15121 '``llvm.load.relative``' Intrinsic
15122 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15129 declare i8* @llvm.load.relative.iN(i8* %ptr, iN %offset) argmemonly nounwind readonly
15134 This intrinsic loads a 32-bit value from the address ``%ptr + %offset``,
15135 adds ``%ptr`` to that value and returns it. The constant folder specifically
15136 recognizes the form of this intrinsic and the constant initializers it may
15137 load from; if a loaded constant initializer is known to have the form
15138 ``i32 trunc(x - %ptr)``, the intrinsic call is folded to ``x``.
15140 LLVM provides that the calculation of such a constant initializer will
15141 not overflow at link time under the medium code model if ``x`` is an
15142 ``unnamed_addr`` function. However, it does not provide this guarantee for
15143 a constant initializer folded into a function body. This intrinsic can be
15144 used to avoid the possibility of overflows when loading from such a constant.
15146 '``llvm.sideeffect``' Intrinsic
15147 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15154 declare void @llvm.sideeffect() inaccessiblememonly nounwind
15159 The ``llvm.sideeffect`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. Optimizers
15160 treat it as having side effects, so it can be inserted into a loop to
15161 indicate that the loop shouldn't be assumed to terminate (which could
15162 potentially lead to the loop being optimized away entirely), even if it's
15163 an infinite loop with no other side effects.
15173 This intrinsic actually does nothing, but optimizers must assume that it
15174 has externally observable side effects.
15176 Stack Map Intrinsics
15177 --------------------
15179 LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
15180 mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
15181 are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.
15183 Element Wise Atomic Memory Intrinsics
15184 -------------------------------------
15186 These intrinsics are similar to the standard library memory intrinsics except
15187 that they perform memory transfer as a sequence of atomic memory accesses.
15189 .. _int_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic:
15191 '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
15192 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15197 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic`` on
15198 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
15199 support all bit widths however.
15203 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
15206 i32 <element_size>)
15207 declare void @llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
15210 i32 <element_size>)
15215 The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
15216 '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and ``src`` are treated
15217 as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the copy between
15218 buffers uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations
15219 that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
15224 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`
15225 intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
15226 multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
15227 ``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
15229 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
15230 target-specific atomic access size limit.
15232 For each of the input pointers ``align`` parameter attribute must be specified. It
15233 must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
15234 both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that boundary.
15239 The '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes of
15240 memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations are not
15241 allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store operations
15242 where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and
15243 aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
15245 The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
15246 buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
15247 element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source and
15248 destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when specified.
15250 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
15251 provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
15257 In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memcpy.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
15258 lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memcpy_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
15259 is replaced with an actual element size.
15261 Optimizer is allowed to inline memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
15263 '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
15264 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15269 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use
15270 ``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic`` on any integer bit width and for
15271 different address spaces. Not all targets support all bit widths however.
15275 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
15278 i32 <element_size>)
15279 declare void @llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
15282 i32 <element_size>)
15287 The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization
15288 of the '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` and
15289 ``src`` are treated as arrays with elements that are exactly ``element_size``
15290 bytes, and the copy between buffers uses a sequence of
15291 :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` load/store operations that are a positive
15292 integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
15297 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the
15298 :ref:`@llvm.memmove <int_memmove>` intrinsic, with the added constraint that
15299 ``len`` is required to be a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size``.
15300 If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of ``element_size``, then the
15301 behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
15303 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no
15304 greater than a target-specific atomic access size limit.
15306 For each of the input pointers the ``align`` parameter attribute must be
15307 specified. It must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller
15308 guarantees that both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that
15314 The '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic copies ``len`` bytes
15315 of memory from the source location to the destination location. These locations
15316 are allowed to overlap. The memory copy is performed as a sequence of load/store
15317 operations where each access is guaranteed to be a multiple of ``element_size``
15318 bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
15320 The order of the copy is unspecified. The same value may be read from the source
15321 buffer many times, but only one write is issued to the destination buffer per
15322 element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and writes to both source
15323 and destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic when
15326 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
15327 provided by a set of unordered loads from the source location and stores to the
15333 In the most general case call to the
15334 '``llvm.memmove.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is lowered to a call to the symbol
15335 ``__llvm_memmove_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*' is replaced with an
15336 actual element size.
15338 The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory copy when it's profitable to do so.
15340 .. _int_memset_element_unordered_atomic:
15342 '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic``' Intrinsic
15343 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
15348 This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic`` on
15349 any integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
15350 support all bit widths however.
15354 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>,
15357 i32 <element_size>)
15358 declare void @llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>,
15361 i32 <element_size>)
15366 The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic is a specialization of the
15367 '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsic. It differs in that the ``dest`` is treated as an array
15368 with elements that are exactly ``element_size`` bytes, and the assignment to that array
15369 uses uses a sequence of :ref:`unordered atomic <ordering>` store operations
15370 that are a positive integer multiple of the ``element_size`` in size.
15375 The first three arguments are the same as they are in the :ref:`@llvm.memset <int_memset>`
15376 intrinsic, with the added constraint that ``len`` is required to be a positive integer
15377 multiple of the ``element_size``. If ``len`` is not a positive integer multiple of
15378 ``element_size``, then the behaviour of the intrinsic is undefined.
15380 ``element_size`` must be a compile-time constant positive power of two no greater than
15381 target-specific atomic access size limit.
15383 The ``dest`` input pointer must have the ``align`` parameter attribute specified. It
15384 must be a power of two no less than the ``element_size``. Caller guarantees that
15385 the destination pointer is aligned to that boundary.
15390 The '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' intrinsic sets the ``len`` bytes of
15391 memory starting at the destination location to the given ``value``. The memory is
15392 set with a sequence of store operations where each access is guaranteed to be a
15393 multiple of ``element_size`` bytes wide and aligned at an ``element_size`` boundary.
15395 The order of the assignment is unspecified. Only one write is issued to the
15396 destination buffer per element. It is well defined to have concurrent reads and
15397 writes to the destination provided those reads and writes are unordered atomic
15400 This intrinsic does not provide any additional ordering guarantees over those
15401 provided by a set of unordered stores to the destination.
15406 In the most general case call to the '``llvm.memset.element.unordered.atomic.*``' is
15407 lowered to a call to the symbol ``__llvm_memset_element_unordered_atomic_*``. Where '*'
15408 is replaced with an actual element size.
15410 The optimizer is allowed to inline the memory assignment when it's profitable to do so.